blob: bae19799976efde4691cc8de075d54d799eb6b84 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6e893b92019-03-26 05:40:51 +01007 2019/03/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200583 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100584 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200585 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-options
589 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - ssl-default-server-options
592 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100593 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100594 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100596 - 51degrees-data-file
597 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200598 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200599 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200600 - wurfl-data-file
601 - wurfl-information-list
602 - wurfl-information-list-separator
603 - wurfl-engine-mode
604 - wurfl-cache-size
605 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100606
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200608 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200610 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100611 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100612 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100613 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200614 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200615 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200616 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200617 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - noepoll
619 - nokqueue
620 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100621 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300622 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000623 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100624 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200625 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200626 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200627 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000628 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000629 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - tune.buffers.limit
631 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200632 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200633 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100634 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200635 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200636 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200637 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100638 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200639 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200640 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100641 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100642 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100643 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100644 - tune.lua.session-timeout
645 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200646 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100647 - tune.maxaccept
648 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200649 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200650 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200651 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100652 - tune.rcvbuf.client
653 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100654 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200655 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100656 - tune.sndbuf.client
657 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100658 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100659 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200660 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100661 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200662 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200663 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100664 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200665 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100666 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200667 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
668 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
669 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100670 - tune.zlib.memlevel
671 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673 * Debugging
674 - debug
675 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676
677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006783.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200679------------------------------------
680
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200681ca-base <dir>
682 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200683 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
684 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200685
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200686chroot <jail dir>
687 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
688 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
689 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
690 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
691 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100692 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100693
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100694cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
695 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
696 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
697 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
698 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
699 set. These sets have the format
700
701 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
702
703 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100704 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100705 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
706 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100707 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
708 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100709 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100710 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100712 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100713 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
714 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
715 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
716 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100717
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100718 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
719 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
720 on the machine's word size.
721
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100722 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100723 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
724 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
725 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
726 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
727 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
728 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100729
730 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
732
733 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
734 # first 4 CPUs
735
736 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
737 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
738 # word size.
739
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
744 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
745
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100746 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
747 # and so on.
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
750 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
751
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100753 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
754 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
755 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
756
757 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
758 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
759 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
760
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100761 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
762 # and a thread range.
763 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
765 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
766
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200767crt-base <dir>
768 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
769 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
770 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
771
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200772daemon
773 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
774 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100775 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
776 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200777
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200778deviceatlas-json-file <path>
779 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100780 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200781
782deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100783 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200784 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
785
786deviceatlas-separator <char>
787 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
788 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
789
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100790deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200791 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
792 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
793 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100794
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900795external-check
796 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
797 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
798 See "option external-check".
799
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200800gid <number>
801 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
802 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
803 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100804 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
805 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200806 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100807
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100808hard-stop-after <time>
809 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
810
811 Arguments :
812 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
813 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
814 SIGUSR1 signal.
815
816 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
817 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
818 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
819
820 Example:
821 global
822 hard-stop-after 30s
823
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824group <group name>
825 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
826 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100827
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200828log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100829 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100830 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100831 configured with "log global".
832
833 <address> can be one of:
834
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100835 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100836 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
837 port).
838
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100839 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
840 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
841 port).
842
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100843 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100844 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
845 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100846 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100847
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100848 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
849 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
850 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
851 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
852 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
853 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
854 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
855 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
856 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
857 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
858 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
859 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
860 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
861 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100862 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
863 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100864
865 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
866 "fd@2", see above.
867
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200868 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
869 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100870
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200871 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
872 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
873 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
874 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
875 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
876 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
877 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
878 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
879 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
880 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100881 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
882 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200883
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200884 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
885 one of the following :
886
887 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
888 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
889
890 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
891 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
892
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100893 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
894 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
895 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
896 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
897 logger consumes.
898
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100899 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
900 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
901 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
902 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
903
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100904 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200905
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100906 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
907 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
908 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
909
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100910 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
911 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
912 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
913 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200914
915 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200916 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
917 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
918 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
919 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
920 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
921 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200923 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200924
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100925log-send-hostname [<string>]
926 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
927 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
928 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
929 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
930 the logs.
931
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000932log-tag <string>
933 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
934 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
935 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100936 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000937
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100938lua-load <file>
939 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
940 used multiple times.
941
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100942master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200943 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
944 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
945 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100946 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200947 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
948 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100949 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
950 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
951 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
952 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
953 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200954
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100955 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200956
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957nbproc <number>
958 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
959 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
960 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100961 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
962 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100963 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
964 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200966nbthread <number>
967 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100968 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
969 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
970 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
971 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
972 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100973 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
974 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
975 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
976 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
977 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
978 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
979 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200980
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200981pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100982 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200983 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
984 starting the process. See also "daemon".
985
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100986presetenv <name> <value>
987 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
988 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
989 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
990 and "unsetenv".
991
992resetenv [<name> ...]
993 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
994 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
995 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
996 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
997 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
998 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
999 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1000 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1001
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001002stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001003 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1004 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1005 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1006 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1007 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1008 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001009 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001010 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1011 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1012 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1013 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001014
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001015server-state-base <directory>
1016 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001017 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1018 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001019
1020server-state-file <file>
1021 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1022 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1023 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1024 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1025 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1026 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1027 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1028 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001029 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1030 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001031
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001032setenv <name> <value>
1033 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1034 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1035 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1036 and "unsetenv".
1037
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001038set-dumpable
1039 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1040 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1041 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1042 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1043 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1044 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1045 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1046 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1047 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1048 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1049 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1050 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1051 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1052 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1053 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1054 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1055 expected when dying.
1056
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001057ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1058 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1059 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001060 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001061 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001062 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1063 information and recommendations see e.g.
1064 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1065 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1066 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1067 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001068
1069ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1071 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1072 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1073 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1074 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001075 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1076 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1077 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001078 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001079
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001080ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1081 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1082 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1083 keyword to see available options.
1084
1085 Example:
1086 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001087 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001088
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001089ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1091 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001092 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001093 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001094 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1095 information and recommendations see e.g.
1096 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1097 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1098 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1099 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1100 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001101
1102ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1104 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1105 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1106 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1107 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001108 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1109 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1110 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1111 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001112
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001113ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1115 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1116 keyword to see available options.
1117
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001118ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1120 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1121 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001122 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001123 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001124 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1125 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1126 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1127 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001128 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1129 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1130 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1131
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001132ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1133 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1134 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1135 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1136
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001137stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1138 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1139 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1140 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001141 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001142 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001143
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001144 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1145 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1146 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001147
1148stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1149 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1150 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001151 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001152
1153stats maxconn <connections>
1154 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1155 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1156
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157uid <number>
1158 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1159 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1160 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1161 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1162
1163ulimit-n <number>
1164 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1165 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1166 option.
1167
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001168unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1169 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1170
1171 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1172 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1173 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1174 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1175 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1176 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1177 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1178 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1179 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1180 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1181
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001182unsetenv [<name> ...]
1183 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1184 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1185 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1186 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1187 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1188 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1189 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1190
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001191user <user name>
1192 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1193 See also "uid" and "group".
1194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001195node <name>
1196 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1197
1198 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1199 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1200 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1201 traffic.
1202
1203description <text>
1204 Add a text that describes the instance.
1205
1206 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1207 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1208 "<" and ">" characters.
1209
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100121051degrees-data-file <file path>
1211 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001212 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001213
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001214 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001215 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1216
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000121751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001218 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1219 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1220 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1221
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001222 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001223 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1224
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200122551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001226 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1227 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1228
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001229 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1230 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1231
123251degrees-cache-size <number>
1233 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1234 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1235 By default, this cache is disabled.
1236
1237 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001238 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1239
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001240wurfl-data-file <file path>
1241 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1242 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1243
1244 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1245 with USE_WURFL=1.
1246
1247wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1248 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1249 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1250 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1251
1252 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1253
1254 Valid WURFL properties are:
1255 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1256
1257 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1258 device.
1259
1260 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1261 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1262
1263 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1264 particular web request.
1265
1266 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1267 used Libwurfl API version.
1268
1269 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1270 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1271 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1272
1273 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1274 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1275
1276 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1277 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1278
1279 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1280
1281 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1282
1283 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1284 with USE_WURFL=1.
1285
1286wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1287 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1288 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1289
1290 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1291 with USE_WURFL=1.
1292
1293wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1294 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1295 thus before the chroot.
1296
1297 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1298 with USE_WURFL=1.
1299
1300wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1301 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1302 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1303 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1304 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1305 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1306 mode is enabled by default.
1307
1308 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1309 with USE_WURFL=1.
1310
1311wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1312 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1313 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1314 - "0" : no cache is used.
1315 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1316 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1317 the highest performing option.
1318
1319 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1320 with USE_WURFL=1.
1321
1322wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1323 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1324 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1325
1326 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1327 with USE_WURFL=1.
1328
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013303.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001331-----------------------
1332
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001333busy-polling
1334 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1335 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1336 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1337 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1338 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1339 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1340 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1341 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1342 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1343 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1344 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1345 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1346 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1347 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1348 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1349 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1350 "poll" pollers.
1351
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001352max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1353 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1354 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1355 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1356 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1357 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1358 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1359 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1360 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1361
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001362maxconn <number>
1363 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1364 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1365 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001366 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1367 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1368 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1369 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001370 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1371 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1372 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1373 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1374 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1375 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001376
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001377maxconnrate <number>
1378 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1379 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1380 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1381 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1382 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1383 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1384 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1385 fairness.
1386
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001387maxcomprate <number>
1388 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001389 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001390 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1391 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1392 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001393 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001394 default value.
1395
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001396maxcompcpuusage <number>
1397 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1398 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1399 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1400 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1401 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1402 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1403 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1404 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1405
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001406maxpipes <number>
1407 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1408 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1409 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1410 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1411 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1412 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1413
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001414maxsessrate <number>
1415 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1416 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1417 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1418 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1419 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1420 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1421 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1422 fairness.
1423
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001424maxsslconn <number>
1425 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1426 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1427 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1428 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1429 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1430 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1431 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001432 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1433 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1434 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1435 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1436 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1437 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1438 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001439
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001440maxsslrate <number>
1441 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1442 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1443 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1444 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1445 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1446 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1447 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1448 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1449 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1450 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1451
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001452maxzlibmem <number>
1453 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1454 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1455 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001456 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1457 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1458 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1459
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001460noepoll
1461 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1462 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001463 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001464
1465nokqueue
1466 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1467 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1468 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1469
1470nopoll
1471 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1472 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001474 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001475
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001476nosplice
1477 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001478 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001479 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001480 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001481 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1482 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1483 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1484 "option splice-response".
1485
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001486nogetaddrinfo
1487 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1488 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1489
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001490noreuseport
1491 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1492 command line argument "-dR".
1493
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001494profiling.tasks { on | off }
1495 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1496 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1497 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1498 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1499 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1500 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1501 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1502 CLI.
1503
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001504spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001505 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1506 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1507 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1508 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1509 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1510 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001511
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001512ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001513 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001514 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001515 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1516 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1517 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1518 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1519 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001520 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1521 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001522 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1523 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1524 openssl configuration file uses:
1525 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1526
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001527ssl-mode-async
1528 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001529 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001530 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1531 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1532 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1533 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1534 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001535
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001536tune.buffers.limit <number>
1537 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1538 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1539 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1540 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1541 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001542 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001543 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1544 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1545 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1546 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1547 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1548 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1549 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1550 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1551 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1552
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001553tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1554 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1555 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1556 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1557 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1558
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001559tune.bufsize <number>
1560 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1561 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1562 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1563 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1564 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1565 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1566 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001567 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1568 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1569 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001570 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001571 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1572 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1573 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001574
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001575tune.chksize <number>
1576 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1577 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1578 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1579 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1580 checks whenever possible.
1581
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001582tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1583 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1584 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1585 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1586 this value. The default value is 1.
1587
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001588tune.fail-alloc
1589 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1590 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1591 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1592 gracefully.
1593
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001594tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1595 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1596 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1597 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1598 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1599 change it.
1600
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001601tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1602 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001603 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1604 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001605 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1606 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1607 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1608 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1609 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1610
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001611tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1612 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1613 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1614 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1615 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1616 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1617 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1618 recommended not to change this value.
1619
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001620tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1621 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1622 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1623 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1624 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1625 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1626 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1627 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1628
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001629tune.http.cookielen <number>
1630 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1631 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1632 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1633 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1634 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1635 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1636 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1637 to change this value.
1638
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001639tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001640 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1641 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001642 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001643 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001644 configuration directives too.
1645 The default value is 1024.
1646
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001647tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1648 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1649 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1650 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1651 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1652 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1653 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001654 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1655 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1656 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001657
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001658tune.idletimer <timeout>
1659 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1660 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1661 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1662 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1663 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1664 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001665 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001666 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1667 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1668
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001669tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1670 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1671 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1672 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1673 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1674 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1675 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1676 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1677 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1678 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1679
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001680tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1681 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001682 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001683 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1684 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001685 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001686 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1687 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1688
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001689tune.lua.maxmem
1690 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1691 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1692 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1693 memory.
1694
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001695tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1696 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001697 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1698 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001699 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001700
1701tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1702 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1703 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1704 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1705 check servers.
1706
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001707tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1708 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1709 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1710 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001711 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001712
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001713tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001714 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1715 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1716 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1717 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1718 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1719 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1720 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1721 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1722 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1723 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001724
1725tune.maxpollevents <number>
1726 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1727 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1728 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1729 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1730 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1731
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001732tune.maxrewrite <number>
1733 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1734 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1735 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1736 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1737 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1738 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1739 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1740 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1741 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1742 bufsize.
1743
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001744tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1745 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1746 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1747 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1748 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1749 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1750 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1751 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1752 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1753 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1754 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1755 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1756 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1757 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1758 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1759 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1760 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1761 setting this parameter to 0.
1762
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001763tune.pipesize <number>
1764 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1765 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1766 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1767 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1768 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1769 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1770
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001771tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1772 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1773 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1774 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1775 default is 20.
1776
1777tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1778 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1779 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1780 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1781 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1782 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1783 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1784 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1785
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001786tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1787tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1788 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1789 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1790 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1791 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001792 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001793 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1794 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1795
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001796tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001797 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001798 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1799 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1800 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1801 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1802
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001803tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1804 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1805 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1806 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1807
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001808tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1809tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1810 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1811 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1812 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1813 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001814 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001815 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1816 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1817 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1818 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1819 notifying haproxy again.
1820
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001821tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001822 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1823 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1824 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001825 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001826 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001827 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001828 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1829 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1830 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001831 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1832 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001833
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001834tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001835 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001836 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1837 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1838 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1839 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1840 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1841
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001842tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1843 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001844 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001845 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1846 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1847 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1848 being used for too long.
1849
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001850tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1851 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1852 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1853 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1854 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1855 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1856 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1857 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1858 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1859 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1860 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001862 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001863
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001864tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1865 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1866 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1867 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1868 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1869 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1870 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1871 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001872 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1873 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001874
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001875tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1876 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1877 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1878 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1879 1000 entries.
1880
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001881tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1882 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1883 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1884 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1885
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001886tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001887tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001888tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1889tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1890tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001891 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1892 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1893 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1894 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1895 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1896 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1897 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1898 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001899
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001900 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1901 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1902 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1903 all available space is consumed.
1904 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1905 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1906 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001907
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001908tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1909 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001910 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001911 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001912 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001913 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1914
1915tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1916 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1917 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001918 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1919 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019213.3. Debugging
1922--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001923
1924debug
1925 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1926 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1927 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1928 system startup.
1929
1930quiet
1931 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1932 line argument "-q".
1933
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019353.4. Userlists
1936--------------
1937It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1938http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1939it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1940
1941userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001942 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001943 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1944
1945group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001946 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001947 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1948 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1949
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001950user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1951 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001952 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1953 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001954 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1955 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1956 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1957 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001958
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001959 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1960 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1961 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1962 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1963 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1964 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1965 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1966 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1967 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001968
1969 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001970 userlist L1
1971 group G1 users tiger,scott
1972 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001973
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001974 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1975 user scott insecure-password elgato
1976 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001977
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001978 userlist L2
1979 group G1
1980 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001982 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1983 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1984 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001985
1986 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001987
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001988
19893.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001990----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001991It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1992several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1993instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1994values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1995automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1996In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1997using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1998tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1999reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2000Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2001that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2002each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002003
2004peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002005 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002006 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2007
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002008bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2009 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2010 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2011
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002012disabled
2013 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2014 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2015 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2016
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002017default-bind [param*]
2018 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2019
2020default-server [param*]
2021 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2022
2023 Arguments:
2024 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2025 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2026 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2027 details.
2028
2029
2030 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2031
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002032enable
2033 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2034
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002035peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002036 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2037 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2038 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2039 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2040 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2041 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2042
2043 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2044 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2045
2046 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2047 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2048 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2049 across all peers.
2050
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002051 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2052 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002053
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002054 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2055 "server" keyword explanation below).
2056
2057server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2058 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2059 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2060 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2061 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2062 of this "peers" section).
2063 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2064
2065
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002066 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002067 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002068 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002069 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2070 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2071 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002072
2073 backend mybackend
2074 mode tcp
2075 balance roundrobin
2076 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2077 stick on src
2078
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002079 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2080 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002081
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002082 Example:
2083 peers mypeers
2084 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2085 default-server ssl verify none
2086 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2087 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020893.6. Mailers
2090------------
2091It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2092If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2093in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2094
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002095mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002096 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2097 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2098
2099mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2100 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2101
2102 Example:
2103 mailers mymailers
2104 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2105 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2106
2107 backend mybackend
2108 mode tcp
2109 balance roundrobin
2110
2111 email-alert mailers mymailers
2112 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2113 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2114
2115 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2116 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2117
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002118timeout mail <time>
2119 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2120 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2121 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2122 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2123
2124 Example:
2125 mailers mymailers
2126 timeout mail 20s
2127 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021294. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002130----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002132Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002133 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002134 - frontend <name>
2135 - backend <name>
2136 - listen <name>
2137
2138A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2139its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2140section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002141section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002142
2143A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2144connections.
2145
2146A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2147to forward incoming connections.
2148
2149A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2150parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002152All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2153'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2154case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2155
2156Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2157logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2158proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2159However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2160name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2161
2162Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2163and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002164bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2166modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2167arbitrary criteria.
2168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002169In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2170a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002171the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002172
2173 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2174 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2175 between responses and new requests.
2176
2177 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2178 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2179 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002180 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2181 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2182 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2183 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002184
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002185 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2186 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2187 client-facing connection remains open.
2188
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002189 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2190 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002191
2192The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2193frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2194following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002195weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002197 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002198
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002199 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2200 ----+-----+-----+----
2201 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2202 ----+-----+-----+----
2203 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2204 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2205 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2206 ----+-----+-----+----
2207 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002208
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002209
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022114.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2212--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002214The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2215limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2216they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2217limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002218marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002219option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002220and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2221with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2222specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002224
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002225 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2226------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2227acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002228appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002229backlog X X X -
2230balance X - X X
2231bind - X X -
2232bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002233block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002234capture cookie - X X -
2235capture request header - X X -
2236capture response header - X X -
2237clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002238compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002239contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2240cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002241declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002242default-server X - X X
2243default_backend X X X -
2244description - X X X
2245disabled X X X X
2246dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002247email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002248email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002249email-alert mailers X X X X
2250email-alert myhostname X X X X
2251email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002252enabled X X X X
2253errorfile X X X X
2254errorloc X X X X
2255errorloc302 X X X X
2256-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2257errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002258force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002259filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002260fullconn X - X X
2261grace X X X X
2262hash-type X - X X
2263http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002264http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002265http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002266http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002267http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002268http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002269http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002270id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002271ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002272load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002273log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002274log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002275log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002276log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002277max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002278maxconn X X X -
2279mode X X X X
2280monitor fail - X X -
2281monitor-net X X X -
2282monitor-uri X X X -
2283option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2284option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2285option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2286option allbackups (*) X - X X
2287option checkcache (*) X - X X
2288option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2289option contstats (*) X X X -
2290option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2291option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002292option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002293-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2294option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002295option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002296option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002297option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002298option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002299option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002300option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002301option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002302option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002303option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002304option httpchk X - X X
2305option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002306option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002307option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002308option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002309option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002310option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002311option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2312option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2313option logasap (*) X X X -
2314option mysql-check X - X X
2315option nolinger (*) X X X X
2316option originalto X X X X
2317option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002318option pgsql-check X - X X
2319option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002320option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002321option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002322option smtpchk X - X X
2323option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2324option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2325option splice-request (*) X X X X
2326option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002327option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002328option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2329option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2330-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002331option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002332option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2333option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2334option tcpka X X X X
2335option tcplog X X X X
2336option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002337external-check command X - X X
2338external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002339persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2340rate-limit sessions X X X -
2341redirect - X X X
2342redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2343redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2344reqadd - X X X
2345reqallow - X X X
2346reqdel - X X X
2347reqdeny - X X X
2348reqiallow - X X X
2349reqidel - X X X
2350reqideny - X X X
2351reqipass - X X X
2352reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002353reqitarpit - X X X
2354reqpass - X X X
2355reqrep - X X X
2356-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002357reqtarpit - X X X
2358retries X - X X
2359rspadd - X X X
2360rspdel - X X X
2361rspdeny - X X X
2362rspidel - X X X
2363rspideny - X X X
2364rspirep - X X X
2365rsprep - X X X
2366server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002367server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002368server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002369source X - X X
2370srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002371stats admin - X X X
2372stats auth X X X X
2373stats enable X X X X
2374stats hide-version X X X X
2375stats http-request - X X X
2376stats realm X X X X
2377stats refresh X X X X
2378stats scope X X X X
2379stats show-desc X X X X
2380stats show-legends X X X X
2381stats show-node X X X X
2382stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002383-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2384stick match - - X X
2385stick on - - X X
2386stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002387stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002388stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002389tcp-check connect - - X X
2390tcp-check expect - - X X
2391tcp-check send - - X X
2392tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002393tcp-request connection - X X -
2394tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002395tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002396tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002397tcp-response content - - X X
2398tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002399timeout check X - X X
2400timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002401timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2403timeout connect X - X X
2404timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2405timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2406timeout http-request X X X X
2407timeout queue X - X X
2408timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002409timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2411timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002412timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002413transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002414unique-id-format X X X -
2415unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002416use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002417use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002418------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2419 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002420
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024224.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2423---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
2425This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2426
2427
2428acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2429 Declare or complete an access list.
2430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2431 no | yes | yes | yes
2432 Example:
2433 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2434 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2435 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002437 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002438
2439
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002440appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2441 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2444 no | no | yes | yes
2445 Arguments :
2446 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2447 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2448
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002449 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450 checked in each cookie value.
2451
2452 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2453 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2454 milliseconds.
2455
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002456 request-learn
2457 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2458 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2459 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2460 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2461 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2462 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2463
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002464 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2465 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2466 data following this prefix.
2467
2468 Example :
2469 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2470
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002471 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2472 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002473
2474 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2475 2 modes are currently supported :
2476 - path-parameters :
2477 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2478 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2479 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2480 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2481 - query-string :
2482 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2483 query string.
2484
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002485 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2486 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2487 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002488
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002489 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2490 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
2492
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002493backlog <conns>
2494 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2496 yes | yes | yes | no
2497 Arguments :
2498 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2499 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002500 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002501
2502 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2503 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2504 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2505 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2506 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2507 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2508 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2509 backlog parameter.
2510
2511 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2512 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2513 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2514
2515 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2516
2517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002518balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002519balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002520 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2522 yes | no | yes | yes
2523 Arguments :
2524 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2525 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2526 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2527 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2528
2529 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2530 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2531 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2532 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002533 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002534 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002535 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2536 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2537 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2538 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2539 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2540 it, so that you don't worry.
2541
2542 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2543 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2544 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2545 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2546 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2547 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2548 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2549 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002550
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002551 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2552 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2553 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2554 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2555 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2556 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2557 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2558 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2559
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002560 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002561 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002562 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2563 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002564 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002565 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2566 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2567 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2568 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2569 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002570 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2571 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2572 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2573 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2574 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2575 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2578 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2579 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2580 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2581 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2582 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2583 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2584 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002585 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002587 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2588 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2589 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002591 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2592 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2593 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2594 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2595 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2596 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2597 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2598 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2599 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2600 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2601 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2602 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002604 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002605 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2606 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2607 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2608 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2609 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2610 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2611 URIs start with a leading "/".
2612
2613 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2614 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2615 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2616 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002619 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2620
2621 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002622 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2623 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002624 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2625 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2626 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2627 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002628 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002629 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2630 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002631
2632 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2633 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2634 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2635 server will receive the request.
2636
2637 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2638 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2639 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2640 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2641 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002642 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2643 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2644 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002646 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2647 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2648 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2649 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2650 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002652 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002653 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2654 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2655 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2656
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002657 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2658 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2659 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2660
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002661 random
2662 random(<draws>)
2663 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002664 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2665 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2666 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2667 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002668 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2669 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2670 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2671 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2672 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2673 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2674 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2675 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2676 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2677 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2678 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2679 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2680 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2681 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2682 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2683 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2684 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2685 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2686 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2687 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002688
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002689 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002690 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002691 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2692 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2693 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2694 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2695 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2696 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002697 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002698 used instead.
2699
2700 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2701 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2702 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2703 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2704
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002705 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2706 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2707 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2708
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002709 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002711 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002712 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2713 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002714
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002715 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2716 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2717 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002719 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2720 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2721 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2722 NTLM relies on.
2723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724 Examples :
2725 balance roundrobin
2726 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002727 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002728 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2729 balance hdr(host)
2730 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002731
2732 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2733 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002735 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002736 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2737 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2738 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2739 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2740
2741 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2742 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2743 defaults to 16 kB.
2744
2745 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2746 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2747
2748 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2749 Round Robin.
2750
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002751 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002752 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2753 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2754 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2755
2756 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2757
2758 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002759 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002760 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2761 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2762 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002764 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002765
2766
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002767bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2768bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2771 no | yes | yes | no
2772 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002773 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2774 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2775 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2776 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002777 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002778 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2779 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2780 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2781 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2782 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2783 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2784 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002785 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2786 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2787 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2788 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2789 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2790 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2791 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002792 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2793 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2794 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002795 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2796 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2797 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2798 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002799 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2800 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2801 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002802
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002803 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2804 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002805 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2806 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2807 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002808 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2809 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2810 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2811 the range.
2812
2813 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2814 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2815 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2816 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2817 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2818 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2819 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002820 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002821 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002822
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002823 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002824 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002825 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2826 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2827 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2828 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2829 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2830 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002832 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2833 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2834 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2835 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002837 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2838 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2839 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2840 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2841 in a frontend.
2842
2843 Example :
2844 listen http_proxy
2845 bind :80,:443
2846 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002847 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002849 listen http_https_proxy
2850 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002851 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002852
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002853 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2854 bind ipv6@:80
2855 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2856 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2857
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002858 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002859 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002860
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002861 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2862 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2863 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2864 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2865 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2866
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002867 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002868 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002869
2870
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002871bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002872 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2874 yes | yes | yes | yes
2875 Arguments :
2876 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2877 may be used to override a default value.
2878
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002879 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002880 option may be combined with other numbers.
2881
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002882 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002883 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2884 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2885 missing from all processes.
2886
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002887 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002888 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002889 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2890 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2891 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2892 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2893 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002894 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002895
2896 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2897 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2898 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2899 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2900 and 'even' instances.
2901
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002902 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2903 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2904 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2905 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002906
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002907 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2908 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2909
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002910 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2911 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2912 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2913
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002914 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2915 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2916
2917 Example :
2918 listen app_ip1
2919 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002920 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002921
2922 listen app_ip2
2923 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002924 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002925
2926 listen management
2927 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002928 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002929
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002930 listen management
2931 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2932 bind-process 1-4
2933
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002934 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002935
2936
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002937block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2940 no | yes | yes | yes
2941
2942 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2943 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002944 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002945 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002946 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002947 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2948 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2949 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002950
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002951 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2952 "http-request deny" instead.
2953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 Example:
2955 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2956 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2957 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002958 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2959 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2960 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002962 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2963 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2964 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
2966capture cookie <name> len <length>
2967 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2969 no | yes | yes | no
2970 Arguments :
2971 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2972 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2973 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2974 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002975 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976
2977 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2978 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2979 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2980 right if it exceeds <length>.
2981
2982 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2983 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2984 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2985 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2986
2987 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2988 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2989 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2990
2991 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2992 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2993 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002994 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2995 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2996 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997
2998 Example:
2999 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3000
3001 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003002 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003003
3004
3005capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003006 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3008 no | yes | yes | no
3009 Arguments :
3010 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003011 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003012 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3013 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3014 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3015
3016 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3017 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3018 it exceeds <length>.
3019
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003020 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003021 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3022 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003023 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3024 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3025 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3026 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003027 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003028 environments to find where the request came from.
3029
3030 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3031 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3032 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3033 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003035 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3036 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3037 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3038 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3039 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
3041 Example:
3042 capture request header Host len 15
3043 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003044 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003046 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047 about logging.
3048
3049
3050capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003051 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3053 no | yes | yes | no
3054 Arguments :
3055 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003056 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003057 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3058 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3059 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3060
3061 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3062 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3063 it exceeds <length>.
3064
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003065 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3067 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3068 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003069 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3070 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3071 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3072 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003074 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3075 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3076 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3077 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3078 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003079
3080 Example:
3081 capture response header Content-length len 9
3082 capture response header Location len 15
3083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003084 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085 about logging.
3086
3087
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003088clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3091 yes | yes | yes | no
3092 Arguments :
3093 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3094 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3095 as explained at the top of this document.
3096
3097 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3098 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3099 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3100 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3101 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3102 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3103 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3104 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003105 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003107 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108
3109 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3110 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3111 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3112 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3113 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3114 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3115
3116 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3117 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3118
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003119 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3120 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003121
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003122compression algo <algorithm> ...
3123compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003124compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003125 Enable HTTP compression.
3126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 yes | yes | yes | yes
3128 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003129 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3130 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3131 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3132
3133 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003134 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3135 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3136 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003137
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003138 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003139 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003140
3141 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3142 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3143 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3144 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3145 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003146 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003147
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003148 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3149 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3150 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3151 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3152 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3153 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3154 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003155 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003156
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003157 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003158 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003159 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3160 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3161 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3162 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3163 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003164
3165 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3166 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3167 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3168 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3169 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003170 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3171 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3172 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3173 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3174 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003175 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3176 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003177
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003178 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003179 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3180 "Accept-Encoding" header
3181 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003182 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003183 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3184 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3185 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3186 "multipart"
3187 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3188 header
3189 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3190 and later
3191 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3192 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003193 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003194
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003195 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003196
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003197 Examples :
3198 compression algo gzip
3199 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003201
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003202contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003203 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3205 yes | no | yes | yes
3206 Arguments :
3207 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3208 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3209 as explained at the top of this document.
3210
3211 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003212 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003213 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003214 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003215 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3216 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3217 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3218
3219 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3220 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3221 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3222 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3223 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3224 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3225
3226 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3227 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3228 instead.
3229
3230 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3231 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3232
3233
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003234cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003235 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3236 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003237 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | no | yes | yes
3241 Arguments :
3242 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3243 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3244 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3245 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3246 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3247 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003248 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003249 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3250 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3251
3252 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3253 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3254 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3255 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3256 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3257 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003258 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3259 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003260 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003261 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3262 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263
3264 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003265 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003266
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003267 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003268 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3269 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003270 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003271 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3272 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3273 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3274 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3275 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3276 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3277 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278
3279 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3280 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3281 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3282 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3283 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3284 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3285 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3286 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3287 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003288 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003289 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3290 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3291 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003293 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3294 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3295 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003296 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3297 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3298 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3299 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003300 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3301 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3302 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303
3304 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3305 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3306 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3307 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3308 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3309 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3310 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3311 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3312 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3313
3314 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3315 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3316 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3317 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3318 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3319 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3320 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3321 persistence cookie in the cache.
3322 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3323
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003324 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3325 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3326 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3327 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3328 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003329 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003330 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3331 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3332 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3333 they logout.
3334
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003335 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3336 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3337 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3338 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3339
3340 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3341 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3342 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3343 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3344 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3345 this attribute.
3346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003347 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003348 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003349 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3350 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3351 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3352 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3353 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3354 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003355
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003356 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3357 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3358 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3359 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3360 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3361 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3362 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3363 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003364 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003365 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3366 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3367 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3368 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3369 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3370 the site.
3371
3372 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3373 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3374 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3375 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3376 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3377 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3378 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3379 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3380 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3381 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3382 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3383 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3384 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003385 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003386 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3387 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3388
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003389 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3390 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3391 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3392 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3393 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3394 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003396 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3397 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3398 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3399 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003401 Examples :
3402 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3403 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3404 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003405 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003407 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003409
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003410declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3411 Declares a capture slot.
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 no | yes | yes | no
3414 Arguments:
3415 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3416
3417 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3418 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3419 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3420 for use in the response.
3421
3422 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003423 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003424 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3425
3426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003427default-server [param*]
3428 Change default options for a server in a backend
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | no | yes | yes
3431 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003432 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3433 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3434 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3435 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003436
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003437 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003438 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3439
3440 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003441
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443default_backend <backend>
3444 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | yes | yes | no
3447 Arguments :
3448 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3449
3450 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3451 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3452 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3453 will catch all undetermined requests.
3454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003455 Example :
3456
3457 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3458 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3459 default_backend dynamic
3460
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003461 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003464description <string>
3465 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 no | yes | yes | yes
3468 Arguments : string
3469
3470 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3471 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3472 it describes.
3473 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3474
3475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476disabled
3477 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3479 yes | yes | yes | yes
3480 Arguments : none
3481
3482 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3483 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3484 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3485 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3486 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3487 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3488 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3489
3490 See also : "enabled"
3491
3492
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003493dispatch <address>:<port>
3494 Set a default server address
3495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003497 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003498
3499 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3500 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3501 during start-up.
3502
3503 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3504 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3505 possible with normal servers.
3506
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003507 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003508 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3509 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3510 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3511 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3512
3513 See also : "server"
3514
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003515
3516dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3517 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 yes | no | yes | yes
3520 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3521
3522 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003523 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003524 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3525 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003526 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003527 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529enabled
3530 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 yes | yes | yes | yes
3533 Arguments : none
3534
3535 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3536 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3537
3538 See also : "disabled"
3539
3540
3541errorfile <code> <file>
3542 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3544 yes | yes | yes | yes
3545 Arguments :
3546 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003547 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3548 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549
3550 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003551 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003552 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003553 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3554 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003555
3556 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3557 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3558 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3559
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003560 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003562 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3563 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3564 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3565 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3566
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003567 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3568 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003570 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3571 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3572 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3575 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3576 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003577 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003578 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3579
3580 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3581
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003582 Example :
3583 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003584 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003585 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3586 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3587
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588
3589errorloc <code> <url>
3590errorloc302 <code> <url>
3591 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3593 yes | yes | yes | yes
3594 Arguments :
3595 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003596 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3597 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003598
3599 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3600 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3601 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3602 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003603 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003604
3605 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3606 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3607 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3608
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003609 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3610
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003611 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3612 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3613 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3614 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003615 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003616 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3617 request.
3618
3619 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3620
3621
3622errorloc303 <code> <url>
3623 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 yes | yes | yes | yes
3626 Arguments :
3627 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003628 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3629 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003630
3631 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3632 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3633 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3634 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003635 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003636
3637 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3638 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3639 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3640
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003641 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3642
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003643 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3644 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3645 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3646 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003647 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648
3649 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3650
3651
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003652email-alert from <emailaddr>
3653 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003654 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | yes | yes | yes
3657
3658 Arguments :
3659
3660 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3661
3662 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3663 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3664
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003665 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003666 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3667 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003668
3669
3670email-alert level <level>
3671 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3672 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3673 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 yes | yes | yes | yes
3675
3676 Arguments :
3677
3678 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3679 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3680 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3681
3682 By default level is alert
3683
3684 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3685 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3686 for the proxy.
3687
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003688 Alerts are sent when :
3689
3690 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3691 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3692 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3693 is notice or lower
3694 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3695 and a health check status update occurs
3696
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003697 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3698 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003699 section 3.6 about mailers.
3700
3701
3702email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3703 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3705 yes | yes | yes | yes
3706
3707 Arguments :
3708
3709 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3710
3711 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3712 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3713
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003714 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3715 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003716
3717
3718email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3719 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3720 mailers.
3721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | yes | yes | yes
3723
3724 Arguments :
3725
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003726 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003727
3728 By default the systems hostname is used.
3729
3730 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3731 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3732 for the proxy.
3733
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003734 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3735 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003736
3737
3738email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003739 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003740 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 yes | yes | yes | yes
3743
3744 Arguments :
3745
3746 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3747
3748 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3749 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3750
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003751 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003752 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3753
3754
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003755force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3756 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003758 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003759
3760 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3761 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3762 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3763 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3764 marked down for maintenance operations.
3765
3766 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3767 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3768 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3769 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3770 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3771 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3772 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3773 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3774 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3775
3776 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3777 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3778 is used.
3779
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003780 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003781 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003782
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003783
3784filter <name> [param*]
3785 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 no | yes | yes | yes
3788 Arguments :
3789 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3790 referenced in section 9.
3791
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003792 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003793 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003794 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3795 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003796
3797 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3798 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3799
3800 Example:
3801 listen
3802 bind *:80
3803
3804 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3805 filter compression
3806 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3807
3808 compression algo gzip
3809 compression offload
3810
3811 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3812
3813 See also : section 9.
3814
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003816fullconn <conns>
3817 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | no | yes | yes
3820 Arguments :
3821 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3822 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3823
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003824 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003825 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003826 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003827 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3828 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3829 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3830 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3831 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003832 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003834 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3835 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003836 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3837 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3838 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003839
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003840 Example :
3841 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3842 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3843 # connections.
3844 backend dynamic
3845 fullconn 10000
3846 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3847 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3848
3849 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3850
3851
3852grace <time>
3853 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003855 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856 Arguments :
3857 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3858 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3859 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3860
3861 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3862 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003863 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3865
3866 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3867 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3868 simplify it.
3869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003871hash-balance-factor <factor>
3872 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3874 yes | no | no | yes
3875 Arguments :
3876 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3877 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003878 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003879
3880 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3881 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3882 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3883 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3884 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3885 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3886 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3887
3888 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3889 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3890 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3891 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3892 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3893
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003894 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3895 consistent hashing mechanism.
3896
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003897 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3898
3899
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003900hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003901 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3903 yes | no | yes | yes
3904 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003905 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3906 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003907
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003908 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3909 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3910 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3911 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3912 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3913 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3914 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3915 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3916 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3917 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003918
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003919 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3920 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3921 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3922 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3923 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3924 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3925 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3926 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3927 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3928 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3929 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3930 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3931 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003932 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3933 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003934
3935 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3936
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003937 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003938 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3939 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3940 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003941 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3942 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3943 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003944
3945 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3946 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003947 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3948 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3949 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3950 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3951
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003952 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3953 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3954 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3955 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3956 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3957 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3958 parameter.
3959
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003960 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3961 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3962 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3963 used on strings.
3964
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003965 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3966
3967 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3968 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3969 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3970 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3971 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3972 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3973 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3974 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3975 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3976 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3977 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3978 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003979
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003980 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3981 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3982 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003983
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003984 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003985
3986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987http-check disable-on-404
3988 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003990 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003991 Arguments : none
3992
3993 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3994 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3995 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3996 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3997 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3998 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3999 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4000 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004001 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4002 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4003 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4004
4005 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4006
4007
4008http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004009 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004011 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004012 Arguments :
4013 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4014 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004015 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004016 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4017 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4018 details on the supported keywords.
4019
4020 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4021 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4022 with the usual backslash ('\').
4023
4024 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4025 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4026 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4027 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4028 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4029
4030 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004031 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004032 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4033 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4034 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4035
4036 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004037 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004038 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4039 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4040 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4041 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4042
4043 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004044 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004045 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4046 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4047 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4048 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4049 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004050 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004051 trace).
4052
4053 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004054 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004055 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4056 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4057 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4058 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4059 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004060 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004061
4062 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4063 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4064 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4065 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4066 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4067 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4068 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4069 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4070
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004071 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4072 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4073 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4074
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4076 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4077
4078 Examples :
4079 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004080 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004081
4082 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004083 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004084
4085 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004086 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004087
4088 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004089 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004091 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004092
4093
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004094http-check send-state
4095 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 yes | no | yes | yes
4098 Arguments : none
4099
4100 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4101 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4102 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4103 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4104 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4105
4106 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4107 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4108 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4109 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4110 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004111 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4112 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4113 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4114
4115 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4116 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4117 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4118
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004119 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4120 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4121 checked in multiple backends.
4122
4123 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4124 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4125
4126 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4127 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4128 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4129 one fails.
4130
4131 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4132 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4133 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4134
4135 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4136 server's queue.
4137
4138 Example of a header received by the application server :
4139 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4140 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4141
4142 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004144
4145http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004146 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4147
4148 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 no | yes | yes | yes
4150
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004151 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4152 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4153 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4154 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4155 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004157 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4158 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004162 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4163 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4164 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4165 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004167 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4168 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4169 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4170 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004172 Example:
4173 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4174 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4175 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004177 http-request allow if nagios
4178 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4179 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4180 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 Example:
4183 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4184 acl add path /addacl
4185 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004187 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4190 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192 Example:
4193 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4194 acl setmap path /setmap
4195 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004199 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4200 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004202 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4203 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004207 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4208 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4209 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4210 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4211 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4212 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4213 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4214 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004216http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004218 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4219 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4220 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4221 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4222 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4223 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4224 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4225 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004227http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004229 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4230 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004231
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4236 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4237 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4238 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4239 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241 Example:
4242 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4243 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004244
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004245http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4250 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4253 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4254 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4255 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4256 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4257 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4258 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4259 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4260 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4263 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4264 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4265 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4266 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4267 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004271 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4272 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4273 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4274 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4275 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4276 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4285 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4286 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4287 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4288 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4289 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004293 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4294 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4295 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4296 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4297 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004298
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004299http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4300
4301 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4302 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4303 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4304 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004305 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4306 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004307
4308 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4313 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4314 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4315 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4316 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4321 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4322 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4323 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4326 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004328 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4329 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4330 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4331 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4332 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4333 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4334 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4335 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 Example:
4338 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 # applied to:
4341 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004343 # outputs:
4344 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004346 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4349 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4352 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4353 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4354 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356 Example:
4357 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359 # applied to:
4360 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362 # outputs:
4363 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4366http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004368 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4369 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4370 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004372http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4375 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4376 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004380 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4381 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4382 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4383 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4384 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 Arguments:
4387 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4388 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004390 Example:
4391 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4392 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4395 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004399 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4400 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4401 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403 Arguments:
4404 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4405 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407 Example:
4408 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4409 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4412 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4413 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4418 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4419 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4420 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4421 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423 Example:
4424 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4425 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4426 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4427 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4428 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4429 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4430 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4431 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4432 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004434http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4437 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4438 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4439 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4440 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4443 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4446 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4447 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4448 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4449 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4450 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4451 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4452 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4453 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004455http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004457 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4458 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4459 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4460 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4461 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4462 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4463 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004465http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004467 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4468 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4469 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004470
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004471http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004472
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004473 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4474 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4475 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4476 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4477 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4478 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4479 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4480 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004484 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4485 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4486 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4487 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4488 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4489 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004491 Example :
4492 # prepend the host name before the path
4493 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004495http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004497 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4498 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4499 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4500 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4501 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004503http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004505 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4506 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4507 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4508 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4509 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4510 values have higher priority.
4511 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4512 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4513 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4514 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4515 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004517http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004519 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4520 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4521 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4522 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4523 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4524 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4525 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004527 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004528
4529 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4531 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004533http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4534 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4535 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4536 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4537 privacy.
4538
4539 Arguments :
4540 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4541 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004542
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004543 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4545 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4546
4547 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4548 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4549
4550http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4551
4552 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4553 expression.
4554
4555 Arguments:
4556 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4557 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004558
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004559 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4561 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4562
4563 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4564 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4565 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4566
4567http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4568
4569 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4570 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4571 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4572 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4573 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4574 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4575 information from the request.
4576
4577 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4578
4579http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4580
4581 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4582 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4583 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4584 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4585 path and the query string.
4586 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4587
4588http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4589
4590 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4591 inline.
4592
4593 Arguments:
4594 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4595 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4596 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4597 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4598 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4599 (request and response)
4600 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4601 processing
4602 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4603 processing
4604 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4605 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4606 and '_'.
4607
4608 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4609 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004610
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004611 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004612 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004614http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4615 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4618 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4619 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4620 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4621 agent name must be used.
4622
4623 Arguments:
4624 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4625
4626 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4627 configuration.
4628
4629http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4630
4631 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4632 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4633 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4634 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4635 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4636 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4637 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4638 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4639 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4640 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4641 action.
4642 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4643 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4644 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4645 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4646 you fully understand how it works.
4647
4648http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4649
4650 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4651 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4652 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4653 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4654 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4655 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4656 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4657 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4658 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4659 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4660 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4661 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4662 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4663
4664http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4665http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4666http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4667
4668 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4669 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4670 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4671 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4672 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4673 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4674 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4675 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4676 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4677 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4678 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4679 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4680
4681 Arguments :
4682 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4683 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4684 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4685 select which table entry to update the counters.
4686
4687 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4688 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4689 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4690 that table until the session ends.
4691
4692 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4693 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4694 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4695 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4696 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4697 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4698 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4699 useful information.
4700
4701 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4702 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4703 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4704 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4705 checks that make use of it.
4706
4707http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4708
4709 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004710
4711 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004712 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004714http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4717 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4718 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004719
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004720
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004721http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004722 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4723
4724 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4725 no | yes | yes | yes
4726
4727 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4728 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4729 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4730 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4731 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4732 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4733
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004734 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4735 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004736
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004737 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004738
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004739 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4740 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4741 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4742 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004743
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004744 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4745 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4746 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4747 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004748
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004749 Example:
4750 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004752 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004754 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4755 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004757 Example:
4758 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004760 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004762 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4763 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004764
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004765 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4766 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004768http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004770 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4771 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4772 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4773 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4774 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4775 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4776 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4777 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004778
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004779http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004780
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004781 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4782 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4783 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4784 example, or to pass some internal information.
4785 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4786 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4787 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004789http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004791 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4792 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004793
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004794http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004796 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004797
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004798http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004799
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004800 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4801 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4802 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4803 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4804 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4805 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4806 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004807
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004808 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4809 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4810 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4811 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4812 keyword.
4813 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4814 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004815
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004816http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004817
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004818 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4819 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4820 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4821 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4822 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4823 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004825http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004827 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004828
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004829http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004830
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004831 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4832 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4833 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4834 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4835 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4836 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004837
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004838http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4841 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004843http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004845 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4846 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4847 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4848 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4849 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4850 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004852http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4853 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004855 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4856 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4857 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4858 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4859 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4860 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4861 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4862 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004864 Example:
4865 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867 # applied to:
4868 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004870 # outputs:
4871 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004873 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004875http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4876 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004878 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4879 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4880 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4881 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 Example:
4884 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 # applied to:
4887 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004888
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004889 # outputs:
4890 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004891
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004892http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4893http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004895 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4896 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4897 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004899http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004900
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004901 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4902 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4903 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004904
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004905http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004907 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4908 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4909 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4910 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4911 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004912
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004913 Arguments:
4914 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004916 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4917 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004919http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004921 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4922 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4923 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4926
4927 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4928 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4929 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4930 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4931 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4932
4933http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4934
4935 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4936 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4937 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4938 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4939 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4940 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4941 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4942 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4943 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4944
4945http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4946
4947 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4948 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4949 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4950 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4951 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4952 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4953 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4954
4955http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4956
4957 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4958 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4959 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4960 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4961 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4962 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4963 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4964 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4965
4966http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4967 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4968
4969 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4970 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4971 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4972 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004973
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004974 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004975 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4976 http-response set-status 431
4977 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4978 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004982 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4983 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4984 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4985 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4986 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4987 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4988 based on some information from the request.
4989
4990 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4991
4992http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4993
4994 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4995 inline.
4996
4997 Arguments:
4998 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4999 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5000 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5001 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5002 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5003 (request and response)
5004 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5005 processing
5006 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5007 processing
5008 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5009 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5010 and '_'.
5011
5012 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5013 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005014
5015 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005020 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5021 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5022 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5023 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5024 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5025 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5026 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5027 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5028 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5029 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5030 action.
5031 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5032 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5033 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5034 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5035 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5038http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5039http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5042 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5043 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5044 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5045 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5046 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5047
5048http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5049
5050 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5051 about <var-name>.
5052
5053 Example:
5054 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5055
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005056
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005057http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5058 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5059
5060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5061 yes | no | yes | yes
5062
5063 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005064 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5065 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5066 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005067
5068 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5069
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005070 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5071 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5072 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5073 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5074 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5075 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5076 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5077 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5078 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5079 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005080
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005081 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5082 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5083 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5084 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5085 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5086 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5087 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5088 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005089
5090 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5091 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5092 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5093 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5094 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5095 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5096 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5097 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5098 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5099 downsides of rare connection failures.
5100
5101 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5102 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5103 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5104 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5105 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5106 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005107 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005108 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5109 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5110 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5111 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5112 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5113
5114 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005115 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5116 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5117 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005118
5119 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005120 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005121
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005122 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5123 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005124
5125 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5126 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5127 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5128
5129 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5130 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5131 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5132
5133 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5134
5135
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005136http-send-name-header [<header>]
5137 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5138
5139 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5140 yes | no | yes | yes
5141
5142 Arguments :
5143
5144 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5145
5146 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005147 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005148 is added with the header string proved.
5149
5150 See also : "server"
5151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005152id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005153 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5155 no | yes | yes | yes
5156 Arguments : none
5157
5158 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5159 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5160 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005161
5162
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005163ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5164 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005166 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005167
5168 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5169 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5170 and running).
5171
5172 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5173 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5174 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005175 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005176 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5177
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005178 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5179 "unless" condition is met.
5180
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005181 Example:
5182 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5183 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5184 ignore-persist if url_static
5185
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005186 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5187
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005188load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5189 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5190 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | no | yes | yes
5192
5193 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5194 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5195 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005196 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005197 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5198 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5199 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5200 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5201
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005202 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005203 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005204 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005205
5206 Arguments:
5207 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5208 named "server-state-file".
5209
5210 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5211 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5212 name is used as a file name.
5213
5214 none don't load any stat for this backend
5215
5216 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005217 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5218 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5219 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005220 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005221 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005222
5223 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5224 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5225
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005226 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005227
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005228 global
5229 stats socket /tmp/socket
5230 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005231
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005232 defaults
5233 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005234
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005235 backend bk
5236 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5237 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005238
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005239
5240 Then one can run :
5241
5242 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5243
5244 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5245
5246 1
5247 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5248 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5249 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5250
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005251 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005252
5253 global
5254 stats socket /tmp/socket
5255 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5256
5257 defaults
5258 load-server-state-from-file local
5259
5260 backend bk
5261 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5262 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5263
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005264
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005265 Then one can run :
5266
5267 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5268
5269 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5270
5271 1
5272 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5273 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5274 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5275
5276 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5277 "show servers state"
5278
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005279
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005280log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005281log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005282no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005283 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5285 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005286
5287 Prefix :
5288 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5289 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5290 prefix does not allow arguments.
5291
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005292 Arguments :
5293 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5294 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5295 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5296 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5297 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5298 parameter.
5299
5300 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5301 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5302
5303 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5304 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5305 standard syslog port).
5306
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005307 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5308 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5309 standard syslog port).
5310
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005311 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5312 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5313 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005314 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005315
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005316 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5317 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5318 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5319 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5320 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5321 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5322 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5323 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5324 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5325 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5326 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5327 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5328 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5329 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5330 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5331 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005332 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5333 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005334
5335 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5336 and "fd@2", see above.
5337
5338 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5339 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005340
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005341 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5342 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5343 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5344 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5345 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5346 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5347 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5348 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5349 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5350 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005351 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005352
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005353 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5354 one of the following :
5355
5356 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5357 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5358
5359 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5360 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5361
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005362 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5363 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5364 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5365 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5366 systemd logger consumes.
5367
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005368 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5369 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5370 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5371 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5372
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005373 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5374
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005375 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5376 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5377 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5378
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005379 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5380 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5381 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5382 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005383
5384 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5385 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5386 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005387 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5388 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5389 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5390 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5391 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005392
5393 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5394
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005395 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5396 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5397 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005398
5399 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5400 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5401 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5402 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5403
5404 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5405 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005406
5407 Example :
5408 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005409 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5410 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5411 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005412 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5413 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005414 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005415
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005416
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005417log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005418 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5420 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005421
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005422 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5423 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5424 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5425 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5426 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005427
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005428 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5429 "option httplog" directives.
5430
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005431log-format-sd <string>
5432 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5433 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5434 yes | yes | yes | no
5435
5436 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5437 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5438 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5439 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5440 which covers the log format string in depth.
5441
5442 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5443 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5444
5445 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5446 log format to "rfc5424".
5447
5448 Example :
5449 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5450
5451
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005452log-tag <string>
5453 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5454 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 yes | yes | yes | yes
5456
5457 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5458 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5459 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5460 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5461 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5462 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5463 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5464 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5465 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005466
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005467max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5468 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5469 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5470 yes | no | yes | yes
5471
5472 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5473 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5474 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5475 servers.
5476
5477 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5478 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5479 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5480 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5481 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005482 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005483 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5484 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5485 picking a different server.
5486
5487 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5488 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5489 even if they have to be queued.
5490
5491 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5492 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5493
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005494max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5495 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5496 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5497 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005498
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005499maxconn <conns>
5500 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5502 yes | yes | yes | no
5503 Arguments :
5504 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5505 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5506 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5507 closes.
5508
5509 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5510 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5511 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5512 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005513 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5514 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5515 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5516 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005517
5518 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5519 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5520 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5521
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005522 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5523 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005524
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005525 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5526
5527
5528mode { tcp|http|health }
5529 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 yes | yes | yes | yes
5532 Arguments :
5533 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5534 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5535 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5536 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5537
5538 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5539 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5540 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5541 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5542 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5543
5544 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005545 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5546 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5547 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5548 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5549 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5550 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5551 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005552
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005553 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5554 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5555 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005556
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005557 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005558 defaults http_instances
5559 mode http
5560
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005561 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005563
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005564monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005565 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005568 Arguments :
5569 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5570 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005571 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005572 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5573 backend and its backup.
5574
5575 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5576 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5577 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5578 servers in a list of backends.
5579
5580 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5581 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5582 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5583 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5584 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5585 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5586 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005587 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5588 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005589
5590 Example:
5591 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005592 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005593 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5594 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5595 monitor-uri /site_alive
5596 monitor fail if site_dead
5597
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005598 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005599
5600
5601monitor-net <source>
5602 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 yes | yes | yes | no
5605 Arguments :
5606 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5607 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5608 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5609 followed by a mask.
5610
5611 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5612 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005613 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005614 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5615
5616 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5617 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5618 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5619 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005620 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5621 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5622 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005623
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005624 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5625 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5626 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5627 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5628 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5629 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005630
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005631 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5632 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005633
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005634 Example :
5635 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5636 frontend www
5637 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5638
5639 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5640
5641
5642monitor-uri <uri>
5643 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 yes | yes | yes | no
5646 Arguments :
5647 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5648 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5649
5650 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5651 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5652 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5653 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5654 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5655 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5656 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5657 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5658
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005659 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5660 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5661 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5662 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5663 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5664 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5665 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5666 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005667
5668 Example :
5669 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5670 frontend www
5671 mode http
5672 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5673
5674 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005676
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005677option abortonclose
5678no option abortonclose
5679 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5681 yes | no | yes | yes
5682 Arguments : none
5683
5684 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5685 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5686 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5687 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005688 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005689 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5690 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5691 encountered while delivering the response.
5692
5693 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5694 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5695 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5696 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5697 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5698 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005699 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005700 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005701 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005702 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5703 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5704 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5705
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005706 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5707 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005708 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5709 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5710 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5711 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5712 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5713 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005714 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005715
5716 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5717 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5718
5719 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5720
5721
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005722option accept-invalid-http-request
5723no option accept-invalid-http-request
5724 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5726 yes | yes | yes | no
5727 Arguments : none
5728
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005729 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005730 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005731 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005732 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5733 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5734 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5735 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5736 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005737 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5738 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5739 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5740 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005741 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005742 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005743 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5744 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5745 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005746
5747 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5748 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5749 been confirmed.
5750
5751 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5752 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005753 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5754 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005755 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5756
5757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5759
5760 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5761 stats socket.
5762
5763
5764option accept-invalid-http-response
5765no option accept-invalid-http-response
5766 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5768 yes | no | yes | yes
5769 Arguments : none
5770
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005771 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005772 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005773 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005774 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5775 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5776 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5777 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5778 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005779 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5780 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5781 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005782
5783 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5784 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5785 been confirmed.
5786
5787 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5788 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5789 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5790 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5791
5792 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5793 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5794
5795 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5796 stats socket.
5797
5798
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005799option allbackups
5800no option allbackups
5801 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5803 yes | no | yes | yes
5804 Arguments : none
5805
5806 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5807 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5808 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5809 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5810 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5811 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5812 order between the backup servers anymore.
5813
5814 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5815 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5816
5817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5819
5820
5821option checkcache
5822no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005823 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5825 yes | no | yes | yes
5826 Arguments : none
5827
5828 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5829 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005830 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005831 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5832 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005833 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005834
5835 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005836 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005837 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005838 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5839 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005840 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005841 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005842 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5843 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005844 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005845 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5846 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005847 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005848 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5849 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5850 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5851 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5852 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5853 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5854 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5855 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5856 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5857
5858 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005859 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005860 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005861 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005862 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5863
5864 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5865 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005866 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005867 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005868
5869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5871
5872
5873option clitcpka
5874no option clitcpka
5875 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5877 yes | yes | yes | no
5878 Arguments : none
5879
5880 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5881 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005882 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005883 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5884
5885 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5886 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5887 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5888 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5889
5890 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5891 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5892 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5893 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5894 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5895
5896 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5897
5898 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5899 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5900 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5901
5902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5904
5905 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5906
5907
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005908option contstats
5909 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5911 yes | yes | yes | no
5912 Arguments : none
5913
5914 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5915 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5916 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5917 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005918 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5919 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5920 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5921 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5922 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005923
5924
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005925option dontlog-normal
5926no option dontlog-normal
5927 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5929 yes | yes | yes | no
5930 Arguments : none
5931
5932 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5933 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5934 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5935 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5936 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5937 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5938 logged.
5939
5940 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5941 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5942 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005944 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005945 logging.
5946
5947
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005948option dontlognull
5949no option dontlognull
5950 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5952 yes | yes | yes | no
5953 Arguments : none
5954
5955 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5956 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5957 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5958 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5959 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5960 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005961 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5962 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5963 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005964
5965 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005966 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005967 would not be logged.
5968
5969 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5970 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5971
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005972 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5973 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005974
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005975
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005976option forceclose (deprecated)
5977no option forceclose (deprecated)
5978 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005979
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005980 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005981
5982
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005983option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005984 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 yes | yes | yes | yes
5987 Arguments :
5988 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5989 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005990 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005991 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005992
5993 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5994 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5995 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5996 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5997 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5998 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5999 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006000 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6001 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6002 possible that the client has already brought one.
6003
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006004 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006005 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006006 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006007 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006008 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006009 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006010
6011 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6012 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6013 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6014 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6015 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6016 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6017 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6018
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006019 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6020 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6021 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6022 are under the control of the end-user.
6023
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006024 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006025 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6026 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006027 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6028 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6029 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006030
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006031 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006032 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6033 frontend www
6034 mode http
6035 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6036
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006037 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6038 backend www
6039 mode http
6040 option forwardfor header X-Client
6041
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006042 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006043 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006044
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006045
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006046option http-buffer-request
6047no option http-buffer-request
6048 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6050 yes | yes | yes | yes
6051 Arguments : none
6052
6053 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6054 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6055 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6056 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6057 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6058 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6059 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6060 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006061 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006062 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6063 default.
6064
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006065 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006066
6067
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006068option http-ignore-probes
6069no option http-ignore-probes
6070 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6072 yes | yes | yes | no
6073 Arguments : none
6074
6075 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6076 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6077 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6078 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6079 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6080 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6081 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6082 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6083 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006084 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6085 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006086 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6087
6088 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6089 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6090 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6091 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6092 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6093 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6094 are often the only way to detect them.
6095
6096 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6097 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6098
6099 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6100
6101
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006102option http-keep-alive
6103no option http-keep-alive
6104 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6106 yes | yes | yes | yes
6107 Arguments : none
6108
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006109 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6110 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006111 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6112 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6113 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6114 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6115 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006116
6117 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6118 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006119 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6120 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6121 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6122 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6123 situations where this option may be useful :
6124
6125 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006126 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006127
6128 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6129 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6130
6131 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6132 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6133 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6134 request.
6135
6136 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6137 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006138 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6139 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6140 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006141
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006142 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6143 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6144 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6145 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6146 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6147 not set.
6148
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006149 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006150 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6151 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006152
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006153 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006154 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006155 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006156
6157
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006158option http-no-delay
6159no option http-no-delay
6160 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6162 yes | yes | yes | yes
6163 Arguments : none
6164
6165 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6166 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6167 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6168 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6169 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6170 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6171 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6172 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6173 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6174 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6175 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6176 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6177 affected.
6178
6179 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6180 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6181 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6182 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6183 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6184 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6185 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6186 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6187 latency environments.
6188
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006189 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6190
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006191
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006192option http-pretend-keepalive
6193no option http-pretend-keepalive
6194 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006196 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006197 Arguments : none
6198
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006199 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006200 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6201 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6202 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6203 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6204 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6205 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6206 consider the response complete.
6207
6208 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6209 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6210 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6211 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006212 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006213 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6214
6215 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6216 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6217 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6218 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6219 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6220 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6221 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6222
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006223 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6224 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6225 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6226 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6227 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6228 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006229
6230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6232
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006233 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006234 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006235
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006236
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006237option http-server-close
6238no option http-server-close
6239 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6241 yes | yes | yes | yes
6242 Arguments : none
6243
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006244 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6245 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6246 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6247 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006248 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6249 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6250 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6251 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6252 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6253 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6254 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6255 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6256 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6257 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6258 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006259
6260 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6261 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6262 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6263 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006264 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6265 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006266
6267 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6268 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006269 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6270 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6271 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006272
6273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6275
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006276 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6277 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006278
6279
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006280option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6281no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6282 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006284 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006285 Arguments : none
6286
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006287 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6288 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6289 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6290
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006291 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6292 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6293 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6294 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006295 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006296
6297 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006298 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006299 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6300 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6301 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6302 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6303 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6304 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6305 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006306
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006307 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6308 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6309 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6310 backend.
6311
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006312 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6313 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6314
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006315 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6316 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006317
6318
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006319option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006320no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006321 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6323 yes | yes | yes | no
6324 Arguments : none
6325
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006326 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006327 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6328 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6329 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6330 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6331 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6332 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6333
6334 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6335 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006336 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6337 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6338 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006339
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006340 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6341 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6342 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6343 front of an existing proxy.
6344
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006345 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6346
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006347 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006348
6349
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006350option http-use-htx
6351no option http-use-htx
6352 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6354 yes | yes | yes | yes
6355 Arguments : none
6356
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006357 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006358 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006359 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6360 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6361 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6362 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6363 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006364
6365 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6366 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6367 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6368 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006369 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6370 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6371 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6372 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006373
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006374 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6375 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6376 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6377 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6378 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006379
6380 See also : "mode http"
6381
6382
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006383option httpchk
6384option httpchk <uri>
6385option httpchk <method> <uri>
6386option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6387 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6389 yes | no | yes | yes
6390 Arguments :
6391 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6392 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6393 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6394 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6395 ones.
6396
6397 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6398 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6399 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6400
6401 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6402 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6403 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6404 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6405 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6406
6407 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6408 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6409 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6410 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6411 the lack of any response.
6412
6413 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6414
6415 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6416 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6417 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6418
6419 Examples :
6420 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6421 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6422 backend https_relay
6423 mode tcp
6424 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6425 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6426
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006427 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6428 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6429 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006430
6431
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006432option httpclose
6433no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006434 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6436 yes | yes | yes | yes
6437 Arguments : none
6438
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006439 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6440 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6441 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6442 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006443 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006444
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006445 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6446 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6447 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6448 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6449 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006450
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006451 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6452 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6453 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006454
6455 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6456 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006457 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006458 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6459 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6460 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006461
6462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6464
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006465 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006466
6467
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006468option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006469 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006471 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006472 Arguments :
6473 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6474 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6475 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006476 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006477 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006478
6479 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6480 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6481 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6482 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6483 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6484 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6485 ports.
6486
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006487 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6488 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006489
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006490 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006492 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006493
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006494
6495option http_proxy
6496no option http_proxy
6497 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 yes | yes | yes | yes
6500 Arguments : none
6501
6502 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6503 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6504 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6505 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6506 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6507
6508 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6509 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006510 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6511 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006512
6513 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6514 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6515
6516 Example :
6517 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6518 backend direct_forward
6519 option httpclose
6520 option http_proxy
6521
6522 See also : "option httpclose"
6523
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006524
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006525option independent-streams
6526no option independent-streams
6527 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6529 yes | yes | yes | yes
6530 Arguments : none
6531
6532 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6533 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6534 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6535 receive data or not.
6536
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006537 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006538 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6539 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6540 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6541 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6542 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6543 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6544 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6545 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6546 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6547 socket buffers.
6548
6549 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6550 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6551 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6552 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6553 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6554
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006555 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006556 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6557 deprecated.
6558
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006559 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006560
6561
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006562option ldap-check
6563 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6565 yes | no | yes | yes
6566 Arguments : none
6567
6568 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6569 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6570 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6571 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6572
6573 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6574 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6575
6576 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6577 configure it.
6578
6579 Example :
6580 option ldap-check
6581
6582 See also : "option httpchk"
6583
6584
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006585option external-check
6586 Use external processes for server health checks
6587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6588 yes | no | yes | yes
6589
6590 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6591 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6592 command".
6593
6594 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6595
6596 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6597
6598
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006599option log-health-checks
6600no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006601 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6603 yes | no | yes | yes
6604 Arguments : none
6605
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006606 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6607 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6608 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006609
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006610 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6611 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6612 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6613 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6614 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6615
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006616 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006617 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006618
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006619 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6620 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6621 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006622
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006623
6624option log-separate-errors
6625no option log-separate-errors
6626 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6628 yes | yes | yes | no
6629 Arguments : none
6630
6631 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6632 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6633 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6634 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6635 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6636 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6637 provides very important information.
6638
6639 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6640 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6641 error logs.
6642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006643 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006644 logging.
6645
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006646
6647option logasap
6648no option logasap
6649 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6651 yes | yes | yes | no
6652 Arguments : none
6653
6654 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6655 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6656 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6657 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6658 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6659 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6660 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006661 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006662 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6663 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6664
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006665 Examples :
6666 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6667 mode http
6668 option httplog
6669 option logasap
6670 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6671
6672 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6673 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6674 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6675 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006677 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006678 logging.
6679
6680
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006681option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006682 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6684 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006685 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006686 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6687 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006688 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006689
6690 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6691 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006692 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006693 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6694 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6695 in the MySQL table, like this :
6696
6697 USE mysql;
6698 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6699 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6700
6701 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006702 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006703 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6704 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6705 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6706 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6707 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6708 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6709 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6710
6711 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6712 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006713
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006714 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006715
6716 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6717 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6718 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6719 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006720 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6721 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006722
6723 See also: "option httpchk"
6724
6725
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006726option nolinger
6727no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006728 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006729 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6730 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006731 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006732
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006733 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006734 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6735 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6736 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6737 connections.
6738
6739 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6740 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6741 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6742 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6743 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6744 this too.
6745
6746 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6747 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6748 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6749
6750 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6751 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6752 for servers.
6753
6754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6756
6757
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006758option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6759 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6761 yes | yes | yes | yes
6762 Arguments :
6763 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6764 matching <network>
6765 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6766 header name.
6767
6768 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6769 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6770 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6771 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6772 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6773 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6774 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6775 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6776 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6777 possible that the client has already brought one.
6778
6779 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6780 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6781 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6782 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6783 header and requires different one.
6784
6785 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6786 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6787 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6788 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6789 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6790 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6791 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6792
6793 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6794 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6795 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6796 both are defined.
6797
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006798 Examples :
6799 # Original Destination address
6800 frontend www
6801 mode http
6802 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6803
6804 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6805 backend www
6806 mode http
6807 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6808
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006809 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006810
6811
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006812option persist
6813no option persist
6814 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6816 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006817 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006818
6819 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6820 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6821 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6822 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6823 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6824 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6825 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6826 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6827 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6828 redirected to another valid server.
6829
6830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6832
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006833 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006834
6835
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006836option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6837 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6839 yes | no | yes | yes
6840 Arguments :
6841 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6842 PostgreSQL server.
6843
6844 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6845 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6846 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6847 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6848
6849 See also: "option httpchk"
6850
6851
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006852option prefer-last-server
6853no option prefer-last-server
6854 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6856 yes | no | yes | yes
6857 Arguments : none
6858
6859 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6860 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6861 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6862 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6863 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6864 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6865 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6866 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6867 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006868 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6869 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006870 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6871 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6872 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006873 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6874 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6875 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006876
6877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6879
6880 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6881
6882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006883option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006884option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006885no option redispatch
6886 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6888 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006889 Arguments :
6890 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6891 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6892 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006893 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006894 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006895 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006896 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6897 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6898 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006900
6901 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6902 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6903 be able to access the service anymore.
6904
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006905 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6906 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006907
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006908 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006909 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6910 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006912 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6913 "redisp" keywords.
6914
6915 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6916 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6917
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006918 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006919
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006920
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006921option redis-check
6922 Use redis health checks for server testing
6923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6924 yes | no | yes | yes
6925 Arguments : none
6926
6927 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6928 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6929 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6930 find the "+PONG" response message.
6931
6932 Example :
6933 option redis-check
6934
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006935 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006936
6937
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006938option smtpchk
6939option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6940 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6942 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006943 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006944 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006945 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006946 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6947
6948 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6949 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6950 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6951
6952 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6953 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6954 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6955 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6956 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6957 dead server.
6958
6959 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6960 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006961 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006962 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6963
6964 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6965 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6966 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6967 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006968 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006969
6970 Example :
6971 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6972
6973 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006976option socket-stats
6977no option socket-stats
6978
6979 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6981 yes | yes | yes | no
6982
6983 Arguments : none
6984
6985
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006986option splice-auto
6987no option splice-auto
6988 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | yes | yes | yes
6991 Arguments : none
6992
6993 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6994 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006995 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006996 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006997 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006998 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6999 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7000 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7001 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7002
7003 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7004 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7005 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7006 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7007 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7008 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7009 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7010 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7011 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7012 keyword.
7013
7014 Example :
7015 option splice-auto
7016
7017 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7018 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7019
7020 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7021 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7022
7023
7024option splice-request
7025no option splice-request
7026 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7028 yes | yes | yes | yes
7029 Arguments : none
7030
7031 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007032 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007033 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7034 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7035 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7036 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7037
7038 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7039
7040 Example :
7041 option splice-request
7042
7043 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7044 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7045
7046 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7047 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7048
7049
7050option splice-response
7051no option splice-response
7052 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7054 yes | yes | yes | yes
7055 Arguments : none
7056
7057 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007058 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007059 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7060 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7061 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7062 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7063
7064 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7065
7066 Example :
7067 option splice-response
7068
7069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7071
7072 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7073 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7074
7075
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007076option spop-check
7077 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7079 no | no | no | yes
7080 Arguments : none
7081
7082 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7083 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7084 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7085 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7086
7087 Example :
7088 option spop-check
7089
7090 See also : "option httpchk"
7091
7092
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007093option srvtcpka
7094no option srvtcpka
7095 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7097 yes | no | yes | yes
7098 Arguments : none
7099
7100 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7101 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007102 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007103 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7104
7105 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7106 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7107 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7108 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7109
7110 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7111 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7112 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7113 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7114 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7115
7116 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7117
7118 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7119 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7120 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7121
7122 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7123 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7124
7125 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7126
7127
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007128option ssl-hello-chk
7129 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 yes | no | yes | yes
7132 Arguments : none
7133
7134 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7135 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7136 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7137 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7138 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7139 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7140 hello message.
7141
7142 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7143 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7144 messages, which is appreciable.
7145
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007146 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7147 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7148 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007149
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007150 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7151
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007152
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007153option tcp-check
7154 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7155 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7156 yes | no | yes | yes
7157
7158 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7159 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7160
7161 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7162 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7163 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7164
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007165 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007166 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7167 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7168 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7169 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7170 only.
7171
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007172 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007173 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7174 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7175 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7176 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7177
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007178 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007179 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7180 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007181 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007182 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7183 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7184 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7185 the respective protocols.
7186 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007187 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007188
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007189 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7190 script.
7191
7192 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7193 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7194 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7195 The "comment" is of course optional.
7196
7197
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007198 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007199 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007200 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007201 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007203 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007204 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007205 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007206
7207 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7208 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007209 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007210 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007211 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007212 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007213 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007214 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007215 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7216 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007217 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007218 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7219 tcp-check expect string +OK
7220
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007221 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007222 (send many headers before analyzing)
7223 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007224 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007225 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7226 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7227 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7228 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007229 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007230
7231
7232 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7233
7234
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007235option tcp-smart-accept
7236no option tcp-smart-accept
7237 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 yes | yes | yes | no
7240 Arguments : none
7241
7242 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7243 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7244 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7245 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7246 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7247 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7248
7249 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7250 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7251 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7252 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7253
7254 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7255 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7256 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007257 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007258
7259 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7260 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7261 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7262
7263 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7264 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7265 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7266
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007267 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7268
7269
7270option tcp-smart-connect
7271no option tcp-smart-connect
7272 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7274 yes | no | yes | yes
7275 Arguments : none
7276
7277 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7278 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7279 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7280 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7281 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7282
7283 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7284 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7285 complex.
7286
7287 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7288 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7289 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7290
7291 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7292 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7293
7294 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7295
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007296
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007297option tcpka
7298 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7300 yes | yes | yes | yes
7301 Arguments : none
7302
7303 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7304 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007305 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007306 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7307
7308 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7309 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7310 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7311 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7312
7313 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7314 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7315 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7316 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7317 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7318
7319 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7320
7321 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7322 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7323 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7324 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7325 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7326 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7327 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7328 backends.
7329
7330 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7331
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007332
7333option tcplog
7334 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007336 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007337 Arguments : none
7338
7339 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7340 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7341 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7342 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7343 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7344 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7345 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7346 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7347
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007348 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007350 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007351
7352
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007353option transparent
7354no option transparent
7355 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007357 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007358 Arguments : none
7359
7360 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7361 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7362 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7363 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7364 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7365 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7366 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7367 appropriate server.
7368
7369 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7370 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7371
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007372 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007373 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007374
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007375
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007376external-check command <command>
7377 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7379 yes | no | yes | yes
7380
7381 Arguments :
7382 <command> is the external command to run
7383
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007384 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7385
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007386 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007387
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007388 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7389 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7390 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7391 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7392 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7393 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007394
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007395 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7396
7397 Environment variables :
7398 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7399 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7400
7401 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7402
7403 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7404
7405 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7406 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7407 for a UNIX socket).
7408
7409 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7410
7411 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7412
7413 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7414
7415 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7416
7417 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7418
7419 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7420 socket).
7421
7422 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7423 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7424
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007425 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7426 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7427 failed.
7428
7429 Example :
7430 external-check command /bin/true
7431
7432 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7433
7434
7435external-check path <path>
7436 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7438 yes | no | yes | yes
7439
7440 Arguments :
7441 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7442
7443 The default path is "".
7444
7445 Example :
7446 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7447
7448 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7449 "external-check command"
7450
7451
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007452persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007453persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007454 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7456 yes | no | yes | yes
7457 Arguments :
7458 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007459 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7460 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007461
7462 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7463 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007464 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007465 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7466 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7467 forwarded to this server.
7468
7469 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7470 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7471 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007472 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007473 a single "listen" section.
7474
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007475 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7476 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7477 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7478
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007479 Example :
7480 listen tse-farm
7481 bind :3389
7482 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7483 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7484 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7485 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7486 persist rdp-cookie
7487 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007488 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007489 balance rdp-cookie
7490 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7491 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7492
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007493 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7494 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007495
7496
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007497rate-limit sessions <rate>
7498 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7500 yes | yes | yes | no
7501 Arguments :
7502 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7503 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7504
7505 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7506 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7507 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7508 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7509 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7510 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7511
7512 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7513 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7514 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7515 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7516
7517 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7518 listen smtp
7519 mode tcp
7520 bind :25
7521 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007522 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007523
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007524 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7525 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7526 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007527
7528 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7529
7530
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007531redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7532redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7533redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007534 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7536 no | yes | yes | yes
7537
7538 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007539 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007540
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007541 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007542 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007543 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7544 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7545 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007546
7547 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7548 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7549 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7550 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7551 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007552 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7553 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7554 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7555 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007556
7557 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7558 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7559 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7560 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7561 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7562 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007563 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007564 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007565 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7566 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7567 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007568
7569 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007570 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7571 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7572 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007573 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007574 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7575 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7576 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7577 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007578
7579 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007580 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007581
7582 - "drop-query"
7583 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7584 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7585 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7586 with a location-type redirect.
7587
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007588 - "append-slash"
7589 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7590 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7591 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7592 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7593
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007594 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7595 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7596 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7597 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7598 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7599 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7600 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7601
7602 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7603 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7604 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7605 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7606 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7607 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7608 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007609
7610 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7611 acl clear dst_port 80
7612 acl secure dst_port 8080
7613 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007614 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007615 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007616 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7617
7618 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007619 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7620 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7621 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007622 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007623
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007624 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7625 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7626 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7627
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007628 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007629 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007630
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007631 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007632 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7633 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7634 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007636 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007637
7638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007639redisp (deprecated)
7640redispatch (deprecated)
7641 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7642 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7643 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007644 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007645
7646 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7647 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7648 be able to access the service anymore.
7649
7650 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7651 redistribute them to a working server.
7652
7653 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7654 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7655 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007657 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7658 "option redispatch" instead.
7659
7660 See also : "option redispatch"
7661
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007662
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007663reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007664 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7666 no | yes | yes | yes
7667 Arguments :
7668 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7669 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007670 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007671
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007672 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7673 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7674
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007675 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7676 the last header of an HTTP request.
7677
7678 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7679 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7680 responses.
7681
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007682 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7683 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7684 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7685
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007686 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7687 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007688
7689
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007690reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7691reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007692 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7694 no | yes | yes | yes
7695 Arguments :
7696 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7697 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7698 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7699 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7700 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7701 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7702 ignores case.
7703
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007704 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7705 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7706
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007707 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7708 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7709 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7710 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007711 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007712
7713 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7714 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7715
7716 Example :
7717 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7718 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7719 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7720
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007721 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7722 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007723
7724
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007725reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7726reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007727 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7729 no | yes | yes | yes
7730 Arguments :
7731 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7732 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7733 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7734 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7735 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7736 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7737
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007738 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7739 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7740
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007741 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7742 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7743 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7744 next servers.
7745
7746 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7747 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7748 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7749
7750 Example :
7751 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7752 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7753 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7754
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007755 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7756 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007757
7758
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007759reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7760reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007761 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7763 no | yes | yes | yes
7764 Arguments :
7765 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7766 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7767 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7768 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7769 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7770 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7771 case.
7772
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007773 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7774 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7775
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007776 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7777 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7778 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7779 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007780 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007781
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007782 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007783 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007784 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007785
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007786 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7787 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7788
7789 Example :
7790 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7791 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7792 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7793
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007794 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7795 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007796
7797
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007798reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7799reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007800 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7802 no | yes | yes | yes
7803 Arguments :
7804 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7805 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7806 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7807 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7808 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7809 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7810 case.
7811
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007812 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7813 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7814
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007815 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7816 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7817 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7818 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7819
7820 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7821 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7822
7823 Example :
7824 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7825 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7826 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7827 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7828
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007829 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7830 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007831
7832
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007833reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7834reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007835 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7837 no | yes | yes | yes
7838 Arguments :
7839 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7840 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7841 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7842 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7843 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7844 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7845
7846 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7847 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7848 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7849 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007850 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007851
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007852 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7853 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7854
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007855 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7856 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7857 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7858
7859 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7860 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7861 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7862 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7863 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7864
7865 Example :
7866 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007867 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007868 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7869 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7870
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007871 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7872 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007873
7874
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007875reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7876reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007877 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7879 no | yes | yes | yes
7880 Arguments :
7881 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7882 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7883 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7884 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7885 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7886 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7887 ignores case.
7888
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007889 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7890 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7891
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007892 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7893 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007894 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7895 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7896 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007897 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7898 not set.
7899
7900 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7901 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7902 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7903 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7904 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7905
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007906 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007907 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007908 # block all others.
7909 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7910 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7911
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007912 # block bad guys
7913 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7914 reqitarpit . if badguys
7915
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007916 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7917 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007918
7919
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007920retries <value>
7921 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7923 yes | no | yes | yes
7924 Arguments :
7925 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7926 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7927 default value is 3.
7928
7929 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7930 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7931 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7932
7933 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007934 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7935 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007936
7937 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7938 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7939
7940 See also : "option redispatch"
7941
7942
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007943rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007944 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7946 no | yes | yes | yes
7947 Arguments :
7948 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7949 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007950 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007951
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007952 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7953 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7954
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007955 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7956 the last header of an HTTP response.
7957
7958 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7959 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7960 responses.
7961
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007962 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7963 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007964
7965
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007966rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7967rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007968 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7970 no | yes | yes | yes
7971 Arguments :
7972 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7973 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7974 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7975 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7976 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7977 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7978 ignores case.
7979
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007980 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7981 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7982
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007983 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7984 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007985 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007986 client.
7987
7988 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7989 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7990 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7991
7992 Example :
7993 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007994 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007995
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007996 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7997 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007998
7999
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008000rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8001rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008002 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8004 no | yes | yes | yes
8005 Arguments :
8006 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8007 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8008 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8009 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8010 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8011 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8012 ignores case.
8013
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008014 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8015 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8016
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008017 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8018 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8019 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8020 case-sensitive.
8021
8022 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008023 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8024 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8025 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008026
8027 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8028 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8029
8030 Example :
8031 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8032 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8033
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008034 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8035 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008036
8037
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008038rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8039rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008040 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8042 no | yes | yes | yes
8043 Arguments :
8044 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8045 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8046 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8047 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8048 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8049 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8050 ignores case.
8051
8052 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8053 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8054 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8055 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008056 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008057
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008058 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8059 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8060
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008061 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8062 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8063 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8064
8065 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8066 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8067 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8068 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8069 are not case-sensitive.
8070
8071 Example :
8072 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8073 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8074
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008075 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8076 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008077
8078
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008079server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008080 Declare a server in a backend
8081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8082 no | no | yes | yes
8083 Arguments :
8084 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008085 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008086 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008087
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008088 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8089 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8090 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8091 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008092 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8093 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8094 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8095 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8096 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008097 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8098 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8099 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8100 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8101 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8102 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8103 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008104 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008105 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8106 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8107 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8108 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8109 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8110 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008111 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8112 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008113 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8114 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008115
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008116 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008117 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8118 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8119 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8120 adding this value to the client's port.
8121
8122 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8123 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008124 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008125
8126 Examples :
8127 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8128 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008129 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008130 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8131 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8132 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008133
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008134 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8135 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8136 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8137 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8138 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8139
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008140 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8141 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008142
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008143server-state-file-name [<file>]
8144 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8145 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8146 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8147 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8148 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8149 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8150
8151 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8152 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8153
8154 global
8155 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8156
8157 backend bk
8158 load-server-state-from-file
8159
8160 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8161 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008162
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008163server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8164 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8165 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8167 no | no | yes | yes
8168
8169 Arguments:
8170 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8171
8172 <num | range>
8173 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8174 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8175 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8176 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8177
8178 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8179
8180 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8181
8182 <params*>
8183 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8184 keyword.
8185
8186 Examples:
8187 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8188 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8189 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8190
8191 # or
8192 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8193
8194 # would be equivalent to:
8195 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8196 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8197 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8198
8199
8200
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008201source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008202source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008203source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008204 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8206 yes | no | yes | yes
8207 Arguments :
8208 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8209 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008210
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008211 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008212 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8213 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8214 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8215 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8216 supported prefixes are :
8217 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8218 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8219 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008220 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008221 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8222 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008223
8224 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8225 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008226 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8227 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8228 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008229
8230 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8231 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8232 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8233 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8234 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8235 <addr>.
8236
8237 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8238 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8239 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8240 port.
8241
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008242 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8243 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8244 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8245 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008246 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008247 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8248 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8249 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8250 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8251 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8252 HTTP header.
8253
8254 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8255 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008256 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008257 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8258 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8259 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8260 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8261 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8262 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8263 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8264
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008265 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8266 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8267 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8268 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8269 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8270 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8271
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008272 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8273 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8274 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8275 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8276
8277 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8278 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8279 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8280 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8281 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8282 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8283
8284 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8285 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8286 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8287 there are two methods :
8288
8289 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8290 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8291 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8292 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8293 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8294 of the client ranges may be used.
8295
8296 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8297 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8298 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8299 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8300 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8301 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8302 same session.
8303
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008304 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8305 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8306 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008307 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008308
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008309 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8310
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008311 Examples :
8312 backend private
8313 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8314 source 192.168.1.200
8315
8316 backend transparent_ssl1
8317 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8318 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8319
8320 backend transparent_ssl2
8321 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8322 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8323 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8324
8325 backend transparent_ssl3
8326 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8327 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8328 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8329
8330 backend transparent_smtp
8331 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8332 # with Tproxy version 4.
8333 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8334
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008335 backend transparent_http
8336 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8337 # proxy.
8338 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008340 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008341 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008343
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008344srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8345 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8347 yes | no | yes | yes
8348 Arguments :
8349 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8350 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8351 as explained at the top of this document.
8352
8353 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8354 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8355 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8356 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8357 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8358 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8359 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8360
8361 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8362 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8363 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8364 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8365 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008366 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008367 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008368 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008369
8370 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8371 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8372 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8373 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8374 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8375 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8376
8377 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8378 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8379
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008380 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8381 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008382
8383
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008384stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8385 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008387 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008388
8389 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8390 matched.
8391
8392 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8393 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8394
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008395 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8396 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008397 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008398
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008399 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8400 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8401 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8402 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008403
8404 Example :
8405 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8406 backend stats_localhost
8407 stats enable
8408 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8409
8410 Example :
8411 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8412 backend stats_auth
8413 stats enable
8414 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8415 stats admin if TRUE
8416
8417 Example :
8418 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8419 userlist stats-auth
8420 group admin users admin
8421 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8422 group readonly users haproxy
8423 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8424
8425 backend stats_auth
8426 stats enable
8427 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8428 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8429 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8430 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8431
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008432 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8433 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8434 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008435
8436
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008437stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8438 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008440 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008441 Arguments :
8442 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8443
8444 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8445
8446 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8447 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8448 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8449 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8450 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8451 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8452
8453 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8454 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8455 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008456 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008457
8458 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8459 report using "stats scope".
8460
8461 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8462 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8463 unobvious parameters.
8464
8465 Example :
8466 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8467 backend public_www
8468 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8469 stats enable
8470 stats hide-version
8471 stats scope .
8472 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008473 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008474 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8475 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8476
8477 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8478 backend private_monitoring
8479 stats enable
8480 stats uri /admin?stats
8481 stats refresh 5s
8482
8483 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8484
8485
8486stats enable
8487 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008489 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008490 Arguments : none
8491
8492 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8493 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8494 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8495 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8496 - stats auth : no authentication
8497 - stats scope : no restriction
8498
8499 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8500 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8501 unobvious parameters.
8502
8503 Example :
8504 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8505 backend public_www
8506 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8507 stats enable
8508 stats hide-version
8509 stats scope .
8510 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008511 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008512 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8513 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8514
8515 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8516 backend private_monitoring
8517 stats enable
8518 stats uri /admin?stats
8519 stats refresh 5s
8520
8521 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8522
8523
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008524stats hide-version
8525 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008527 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008528 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008529
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008530 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8531 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8532 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8533 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8534 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8535 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008537 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8538 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8539 unobvious parameters.
8540
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008541 Example :
8542 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8543 backend public_www
8544 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008545 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008546 stats hide-version
8547 stats scope .
8548 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008549 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008550 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8551 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008552
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008553 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8554 backend private_monitoring
8555 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008556 stats uri /admin?stats
8557 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008558
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008559 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008560
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008561
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008562stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8563 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8564 Access control for statistics
8565
8566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8567 no | no | yes | yes
8568
8569 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8570 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8571 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8572 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8573 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8574 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8575
8576 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8577 instance.
8578
8579 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8580 about ACL usage.
8581
8582
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008583stats realm <realm>
8584 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008586 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008587 Arguments :
8588 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8589 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8590 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8591
8592 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8593 using a backslash ('\').
8594
8595 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8596 only related to authentication.
8597
8598 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8599 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8600 unobvious parameters.
8601
8602 Example :
8603 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8604 backend public_www
8605 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8606 stats enable
8607 stats hide-version
8608 stats scope .
8609 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008610 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008611 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8612 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8613
8614 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8615 backend private_monitoring
8616 stats enable
8617 stats uri /admin?stats
8618 stats refresh 5s
8619
8620 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8621
8622
8623stats refresh <delay>
8624 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008626 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008627 Arguments :
8628 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8629 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8630 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8631 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8632 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8633 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8634
8635 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8636 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8637 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8638 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8639
8640 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8641 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8642 unobvious parameters.
8643
8644 Example :
8645 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8646 backend public_www
8647 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8648 stats enable
8649 stats hide-version
8650 stats scope .
8651 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008652 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008653 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8654 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8655
8656 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8657 backend private_monitoring
8658 stats enable
8659 stats uri /admin?stats
8660 stats refresh 5s
8661
8662 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8663
8664
8665stats scope { <name> | "." }
8666 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008668 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008669 Arguments :
8670 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8671 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8672 section in which the statement appears.
8673
8674 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8675 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8676 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8677 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8678 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8679 exists.
8680
8681 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8682 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8683 unobvious parameters.
8684
8685 Example :
8686 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8687 backend public_www
8688 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8689 stats enable
8690 stats hide-version
8691 stats scope .
8692 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008693 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008694 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8695 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8696
8697 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8698 backend private_monitoring
8699 stats enable
8700 stats uri /admin?stats
8701 stats refresh 5s
8702
8703 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8704
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008705
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008706stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008707 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008709 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008710
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008711 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008712 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8713
8714 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8715 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8716
8717 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8718 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008719 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008720
8721 Example :
8722 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8723 backend private_monitoring
8724 stats enable
8725 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8726 stats uri /admin?stats
8727 stats refresh 5s
8728
8729 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8730 global section.
8731
8732
8733stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008734 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8736 yes | yes | yes | yes
8737 Arguments : none
8738
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008739 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008740 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8741 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8742 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8743 - IP (socket, server)
8744 - cookie (backend, server)
8745
8746 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8747 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008748 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008749
8750 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8751
8752
8753stats show-node [ <name> ]
8754 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008756 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008757 Arguments:
8758 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8759 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8760
8761 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8762 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008763 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008764
8765 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8766 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8767 unobvious parameters.
8768
8769 Example:
8770 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8771 backend private_monitoring
8772 stats enable
8773 stats show-node Europe-1
8774 stats uri /admin?stats
8775 stats refresh 5s
8776
8777 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8778 section.
8779
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008780
8781stats uri <prefix>
8782 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008784 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008785 Arguments :
8786 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8787 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8788 query string.
8789
8790 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8791 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8792 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8793 possible to reach it in the application.
8794
8795 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008796 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008797 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8798 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8799 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8800 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8801
8802 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8803 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8804 an address or a port to statistics only.
8805
8806 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8807 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8808 unobvious parameters.
8809
8810 Example :
8811 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8812 backend public_www
8813 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8814 stats enable
8815 stats hide-version
8816 stats scope .
8817 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008818 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008819 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8820 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8821
8822 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8823 backend private_monitoring
8824 stats enable
8825 stats uri /admin?stats
8826 stats refresh 5s
8827
8828 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8829
8830
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008831stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8832 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008834 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008835
8836 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008837 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008838 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008839 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008840 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8841
8842 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8843 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8844 the "stick-table" statement.
8845
8846 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8847 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8848 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8849 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8850 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8851
8852 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8853 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8854 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8855 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8856 transformation rules.
8857
8858 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8859 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8860 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8861 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8862 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8863 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8864 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8865
8866 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8867 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8868 ACL based conditions.
8869
8870 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8871 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8872 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8873 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8874
8875 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8876 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8877 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8878 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8879
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008880 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8881 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008882 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008883
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008884 Example :
8885 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8886 # last 30 minutes
8887 backend pop
8888 mode tcp
8889 balance roundrobin
8890 stick store-request src
8891 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8892 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8893 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8894
8895 backend smtp
8896 mode tcp
8897 balance roundrobin
8898 stick match src table pop
8899 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8900 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8901
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008902 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008903 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008904
8905
8906stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8907 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8909 no | no | yes | yes
8910
8911 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8912 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8913 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8914 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8915
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008916 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8917 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008918 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008919
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008920 Examples :
8921 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008922 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008923
8924 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8925 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8926 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8927
8928
8929 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8930 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8931 backend http
8932 mode http
8933 balance roundrobin
8934 stick on src table https
8935 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8936 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8937 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8938
8939 backend https
8940 mode tcp
8941 balance roundrobin
8942 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8943 stick on src
8944 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8945 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8946
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008947 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008948
8949
8950stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8951 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8953 no | no | yes | yes
8954
8955 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008956 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008957 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008958 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008959 server is selected.
8960
8961 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8962 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8963 the "stick-table" statement.
8964
8965 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8966 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8967 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8968 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8969 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8970 address.
8971
8972 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8973 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8974 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8975 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8976 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8977 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8978 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8979 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8980 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8981 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8982
8983 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8984 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8985 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8986 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8987 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8988 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8989 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8990
8991 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8992 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8993 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8994 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8995
8996 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8997 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8998 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8999 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9000 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9001 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009002 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9003 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9004 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9005 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9006 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9007 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009008
9009 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9010 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9011 the request.
9012
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009013 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9014 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009015 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009016
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009017 Example :
9018 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9019 # last 30 minutes
9020 backend pop
9021 mode tcp
9022 balance roundrobin
9023 stick store-request src
9024 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9025 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9026 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9027
9028 backend smtp
9029 mode tcp
9030 balance roundrobin
9031 stick match src table pop
9032 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9033 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9034
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009035 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009036 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009037
9038
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009039stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009040 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9041 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009042 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009044 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009045
9046 Arguments :
9047 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9048 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9049 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9050 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9051
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009052 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9053 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9054 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9055 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9056
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009057 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9058 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9059 instance.
9060
9061 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9062 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9063 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9064 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9065 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9066 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009067 to 32 characters.
9068
9069 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9070 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9071 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009072 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009073 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9074 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009075
9076 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009077 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9078 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009079 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9080 increase.
9081
9082 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009083 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9084 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9085 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009086
9087 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9088 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9089 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9090 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009091 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009092 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9093 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9094 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9095 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9096 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9097 parameter (see below).
9098
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009099 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9100 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9101 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9102 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9103 soft restart.
9104
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009105 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9106 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009107
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009108 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9109 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9110 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9111 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009112 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009113 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009114 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9115 if not expiration delay is specified.
9116
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009117 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9118 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9119 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9120 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009121 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9122 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9123 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9124 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9125 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9126 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9127 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9128 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9129 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9130 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9131 types and their arguments.
9132
9133 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9134 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9135 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9136 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9137
9138 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9139 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9140 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009141 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009142
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009143 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9144 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9145 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009146 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009147 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009148 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009149
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009150 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9151 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9152 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9153 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9154
9155 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9156 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9157 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9158 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9159 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9160 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9161
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009162 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9163 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9164 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9165 they were received.
9166
9167 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9168 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9169 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9170 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9171 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9172
9173 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9174 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9175 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9176 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9177 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9178
9179 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9180 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9181 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9182
9183 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9184 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9185 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9186 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9187 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9188
9189 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9190 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9191 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9192 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9193 the client side.
9194
9195 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9196 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9197 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9198 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9199 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9200 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9201 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9202
9203 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9204 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9205 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9206 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9207 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9208 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009209 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009210
9211 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9212 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9213 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9214 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9215 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9216 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9217
9218 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009219 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009220 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9221 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9222
9223 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9224 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9225 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9226 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9227 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9228 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9229 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9230 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9231 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9232 recommended for better fairness.
9233
9234 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009235 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009236 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9237 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9238
9239 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9240 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9241 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9242 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9243 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9244 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9245 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9246 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9247 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9248 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009249
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009250 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9251 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009252 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9253 reference it.
9254
9255 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9256 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009257 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9258 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9259 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009260
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009261 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9262 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9263 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9264 something that can be ignored.
9265
9266 Example:
9267 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9268 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9269 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9270 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9271
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009272 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009273 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009274
9275
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009276stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009277 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9279 no | no | yes | yes
9280
9281 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009282 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009283 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009284 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009285 server is selected.
9286
9287 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9288 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9289 the "stick-table" statement.
9290
9291 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9292 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9293 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9294 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9295
9296 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9297 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9298 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9299 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9300 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9301 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009302 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009303 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9304 rules.
9305
9306 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9307 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9308 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9309 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9310 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9311 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9312 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9313
9314 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9315 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9316 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9317 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9318
9319 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9320 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9321 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9322 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9323 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9324 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009325 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9326 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9327 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9328 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9329 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9330 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9331 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9332 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9333 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009334
9335 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9336
9337 Example :
9338 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9339 backend https
9340 mode tcp
9341 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009342 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009343 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009344
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009345 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9346 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9347
9348 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9349 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9350 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9351
9352 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9353 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009354
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009355 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9356 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9357 # at offset 44.
9358
9359 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9360 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9361
9362 # Learn on response if server hello.
9363 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009364
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009365 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9366 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9367
9368 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9369 extraction.
9370
9371
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009372tcp-check connect [params*]
9373 Opens a new connection
9374 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9375 no | no | yes | yes
9376
9377 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9378 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9379 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9380
9381 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9382 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9383 of the sequence.
9384
9385 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9386 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9387 do.
9388
9389 Parameters :
9390 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9391 use the TCP connection.
9392
9393 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9394 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9395 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9396
9397 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9398
9399 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9400
9401 Examples:
9402 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9403 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9404 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9405 option tcp-check
9406 tcp-check connect
9407 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9408 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9409 tcp-check send \r\n
9410 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9411 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9412 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9413 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9414 tcp-check send \r\n
9415 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9416 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9417
9418 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9419 option tcp-check
9420 tcp-check connect port 110
9421 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9422 tcp-check connect port 143
9423 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9424 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9425
9426 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9427
9428
9429tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009430 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9432 no | no | yes | yes
9433
9434 Arguments :
9435 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9436 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9437 binary.
9438 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9439 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9440 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9441
9442 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9443 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9444 with the usual backslash ('\').
9445 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009446 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009447 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9448 used upper or lower case.
9449
9450
9451 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9452
9453 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9454 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9455 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9456 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9457 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9458 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9459 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9460 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9461
9462 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9463 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9464 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9465 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9466 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9467 expression.
9468
9469 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9470 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9471 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9472 this exact hexadecimal string.
9473 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9474
9475 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9476 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9477 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9478 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9479 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9480 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9481 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9482 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9483 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9484 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9485 the null character.
9486
9487 Examples :
9488 # perform a POP check
9489 option tcp-check
9490 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9491
9492 # perform an IMAP check
9493 option tcp-check
9494 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9495
9496 # look for the redis master server
9497 option tcp-check
9498 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009499 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009500 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9501 tcp-check expect string role:master
9502 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9503 tcp-check expect string +OK
9504
9505
9506 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9507 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9508
9509
9510tcp-check send <data>
9511 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9512 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9513 no | no | yes | yes
9514
9515 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9516 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9517
9518 Examples :
9519 # look for the redis master server
9520 option tcp-check
9521 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9522 tcp-check expect string role:master
9523
9524 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9525 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9526
9527
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009528tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9529 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009530 tcp health check
9531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9532 no | no | yes | yes
9533
9534 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9535 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009536 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009537 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9538 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9539 hexadecimal string.
9540 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9541
9542 Examples :
9543 # redis check in binary
9544 option tcp-check
9545 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9546 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9547
9548
9549 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9550 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9551
9552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009553tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9554 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9556 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009557 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009558 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9559 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009560
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009561 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009562
9563 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9564 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009565 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9566 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9567 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9568 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9569 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9570 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009571
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009572 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9573 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9574 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9575 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009576
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009577 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009578 - accept :
9579 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9580 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9581 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009583 - reject :
9584 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9585 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9586 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9587 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9588 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9589 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9590 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9591 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9592 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9593 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9594 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009595 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009596
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009597 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9598 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9599 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9600 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9601 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9602 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9603 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9604 hosts.
9605
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009606 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9607 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9608 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9609 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9610 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9611 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9612 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9613 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9614
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009615 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9616 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9617 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9618 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9619 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9620 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9621 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9622 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9623 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009624 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9625 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009626
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009627 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009628 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009629 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9630 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9631 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9632 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9633 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9634 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9635 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9636 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9637 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9638 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9639 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9640 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009641
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009642 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009643 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009644 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009645 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009646 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9647 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9648 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009649
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009650 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9651 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9652 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9653 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009654
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009655 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9656 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9657 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9658 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9659 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009660 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9661 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9662 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9663 layer7 information is extracted.
9664
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009665 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9666 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9667 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9668 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9669 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009670
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009671 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9672 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9673 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9674 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9675
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009676 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9677 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9678 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9679 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9680
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009681 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9682 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9683 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9684 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9685 continues.
9686
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009687 - set-src <expr> :
9688 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9689 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9690 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009691 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009693 Arguments:
9694 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9695 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009696
9697 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009698 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9699
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009700 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9701 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009702
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009703 - set-src-port <expr> :
9704 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9705 expression.
9706
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009707 Arguments:
9708 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9709 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009710
9711 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009712 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9713
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009714 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9715 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9716 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009717
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009718 - set-dst <expr> :
9719 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9720 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9721 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9722 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9723 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9724
9725 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9726 followed by some converters.
9727
9728 Example:
9729
9730 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9731 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9732
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009733 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9734 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9735
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009736 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9737 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9738 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9739 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9740
9741
9742 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9743 followed by some converters.
9744
9745 Example:
9746
9747 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9748
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009749 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9750 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9751 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9752
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009753 - "silent-drop" :
9754 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009755 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009756 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9757 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9758 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9759 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9760 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009761 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9762 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009763 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9764 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009765 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009766 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9767 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9768 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9769 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9770
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009771 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9772 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9773 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009774
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009775 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9776 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9777 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009778
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009779 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009780 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009781 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009782
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009783 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9784 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9785 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009787 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009788 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9789 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009790
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009791 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9792
9793 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9794
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009795 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9796
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009797 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009798
9799
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009800tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9801 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009803 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009804 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009805 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9806 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009807
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009808 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009809
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009810 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009811 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9812 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9813 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9814 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009815
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009816 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9817 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9818 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9819 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009820 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9821 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9822 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9823 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9824 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9825 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009826 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009827 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009828
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009829 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9830 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9831 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9832 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009833
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009834 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009835 - accept : the request is accepted
9836 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9837 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009838 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009839 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009840 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009841 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009842 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009843 - set-dst <expr>
9844 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009845 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009846 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009847 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009848 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009849
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009850 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9851 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009852
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009853 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9854 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9855 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9856 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9857 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9858 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009860 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009861 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9862 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009863
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009864 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009865 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9866 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9867 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9868 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009869 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9870 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9871 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009872
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009873 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009874 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9875 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9876 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009877
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009878 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9879 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9880
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009881 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009882 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9883 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009884
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009885 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9886 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009887 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009888 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9889 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009890 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009891 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009892 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009893 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9894 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009895 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009896 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9897 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009898
9899 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9900 followed by some converters.
9901
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009902 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9903 <var-name>.
9904
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009905 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9906 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9907 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9908 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9909 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9910
9911 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9912 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9913 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9914 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9915 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9916 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9917 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9918 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9919 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9920 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9921 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9922
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009923 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9924 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9925 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9926 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9927 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9928
9929 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9930
9931 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9932
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009933 Example:
9934
9935 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009936 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009937
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009938 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009939 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9940 # and reject everything else.
9941 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9942 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009943 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009944 tcp-request content reject
9945
9946 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009947 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9948 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9949 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009950 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009951
9952 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9953 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9954 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009955 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009956 tcp-request content reject
9957
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009958 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009959 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009960 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009961 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009962 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9963 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009964
9965 Example:
9966 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9967 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009968 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009969
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009970 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009971 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009972
9973 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009974 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009975 # protecting all our sites
9976 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009977 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9978 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009979 ...
9980 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9981
9982 backend http_dynamic
9983 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009984 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009985 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009986 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009987 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009988 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009989 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009991 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009992
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009993 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9994 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009995
9996
9997tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9998 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010000 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010001 Arguments :
10002 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10003 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10004 as explained at the top of this document.
10005
10006 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10007 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10008 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10009 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10010 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10011
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010012 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10013 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10014 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10015 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10016
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010017 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10018 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010019 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010020 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010021 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10022 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10023 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10024 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010025
10026 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10027 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10028 it pass through unaffected.
10029
10030 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10031 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10032 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010033 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010034 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10035 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010036 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10037 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10038 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010039
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010040 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010041 "timeout client".
10042
10043
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010044tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10045 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10047 no | no | yes | yes
10048 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010049 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10050 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010051
10052 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10053
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010054 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010055 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10056 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010057 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10058 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010059
10060 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10061
10062 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10063 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10064 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10065 inserted.
10066
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010067 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010068 - accept :
10069 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10070 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10071 the rules evaluation.
10072
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010073 - close :
10074 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10075 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10076 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10077 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10078 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10079 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010080 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010081 protocols.
10082
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010083 - reject :
10084 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10085 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010086 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010087
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010088 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10089 Sets a variable.
10090
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010091 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10092 Unsets a variable.
10093
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010094 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10095 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10096 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10097 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10098
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010099 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10100 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10101 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10102 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10103
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010104 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10105 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10106 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10107 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10108 continues.
10109
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010110 - "silent-drop" :
10111 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010112 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010113 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10114 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10115 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10116 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10117 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010118 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10119 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010120 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10121 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010122 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010123 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10124 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10125 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10126 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10127
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010128 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10129 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10130
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010131 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10132 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10133 for changing the default action to a reject.
10134
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010135 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10136 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10137 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10138 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010139 period.
10140
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010141 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10142 declared inline.
10143
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010144 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10145 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010146 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010147 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10148 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010149 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010150 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010151 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010152 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10153 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010154 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010155 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10156 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010157
10158 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10159 followed by some converters.
10160
10161 Example:
10162
10163 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10164
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010165 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10166 <var-name>.
10167
10168 Example:
10169
10170 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10171
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010172 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10173 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10174 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10175 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10176 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10177
10178 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10179
10180 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10181
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010182 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10183
10184 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10185
10186
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010187tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10188 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10190 no | yes | yes | no
10191 Arguments :
10192 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10193 below.
10194
10195 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10196
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010197 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010198 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10199 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10200 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10201 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10202 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10203 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10204 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010205 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010206 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10207 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10208 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10209 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10210 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10211 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10212 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10213 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10214 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10215 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10216 instead.
10217
10218 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10219 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10220 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10221 rules which may be inserted.
10222
10223 Several types of actions are supported :
10224 - accept : the request is accepted
10225 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10226 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10227 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010228 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010229 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10230 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010231 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010232 - silent-drop
10233
10234 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10235 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10236 sections for a complete description.
10237
10238 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10239 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10240 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10241
10242 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10243 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10244 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10245 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10246 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10247
10248 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10249 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10250
10251 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10252 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10253 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10254
10255 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10256 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10257 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10258
10259 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10260 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10261 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10262
10263 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10264 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10265 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10266
10267 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10268
10269 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10270
10271
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010272tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10273 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10275 no | no | yes | yes
10276 Arguments :
10277 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10278 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10279 as explained at the top of this document.
10280
10281 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10282
10283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010284timeout check <timeout>
10285 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10286 established.
10287
10288 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10289 yes | no | yes | yes
10290 Arguments:
10291 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10292 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10293 as explained at the top of this document.
10294
10295 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10296 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010297 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010298 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010299 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10300 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10301 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010302
10303 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10304 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10305
10306 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10307 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010308 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010309
10310 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10311 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10312 forget about it.
10313
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010314 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10315 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010316
10317
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010318timeout client <timeout>
10319timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10320 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10322 yes | yes | yes | no
10323 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010324 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10326 as explained at the top of this document.
10327
10328 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10329 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10330 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010331 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10332 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10333 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10334 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010335 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10336 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10337 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010338 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010339 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010340 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10341 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010342 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10343 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010344
10345 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10346 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10347 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10348 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10349 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10350 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10351
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010352 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010354 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10355 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10356 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10357
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010358 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10359 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010360
10361
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010362timeout client-fin <timeout>
10363 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10365 yes | yes | yes | no
10366 Arguments :
10367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10369 as explained at the top of this document.
10370
10371 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10372 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10373 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10374 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10375 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10376 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10377 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010378 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10379 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10380 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010381
10382 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10383 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10384 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10385
10386 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10387
10388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010389timeout connect <timeout>
10390timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10391 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10393 yes | no | yes | yes
10394 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010395 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010396 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10397 as explained at the top of this document.
10398
10399 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010400 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010401 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010402 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010403 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10404 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010405
10406 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10407 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10408 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10409 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10410 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10411 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10412
10413 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10414 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10415 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10416
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010417 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10418 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010419
10420
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010421timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10422 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10424 yes | yes | yes | yes
10425 Arguments :
10426 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10427 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10428 as explained at the top of this document.
10429
10430 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10431 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10432 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10433 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10434 once the request has started to present itself.
10435
10436 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10437 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10438 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10439 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10440 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10441
10442 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10443 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10444 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10445 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10446
10447 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10448 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010449 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010450 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10451 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010452 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010453
10454 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10455 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10456 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10457 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10458
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010459 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10460 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010461 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10462
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010463 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10464
10465
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010466timeout http-request <timeout>
10467 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010469 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010471 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010472 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10473 as explained at the top of this document.
10474
10475 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10476 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10477 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10478 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10479 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10480 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10481 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010482 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10483 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10484 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10485 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010486 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010487 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10488 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010489
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010490 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10491 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10492 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10493 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10494 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010495 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010496
10497 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10498 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010499 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010500 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10501 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10502
10503 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010504 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10505 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10506 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010507
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010508 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010509 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010510
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010511
10512timeout queue <timeout>
10513 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10515 yes | no | yes | yes
10516 Arguments :
10517 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10518 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10519 as explained at the top of this document.
10520
10521 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10522 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10523 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10524 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10525 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10526
10527 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10528 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10529 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10530 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10531
10532 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10533
10534
10535timeout server <timeout>
10536timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10537 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10539 yes | no | yes | yes
10540 Arguments :
10541 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10542 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10543 as explained at the top of this document.
10544
10545 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10546 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10547 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10548 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10549 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10550 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10551 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10552
10553 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10554 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10555 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10556 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10557 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010558 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010559 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010560 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10561 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010562 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10563 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010564
10565 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10566 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10567 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10568 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10569 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10570 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10571
10572 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10573 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10574 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10575
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010576 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010577
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010578
10579timeout server-fin <timeout>
10580 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10582 yes | no | yes | yes
10583 Arguments :
10584 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10585 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10586 as explained at the top of this document.
10587
10588 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10589 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10590 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10591 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10592 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10593 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10594 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10595 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10596 situations, it should not be needed.
10597
10598 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10599 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10600 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10601
10602 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10603
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010604
10605timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010606 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10608 yes | yes | yes | yes
10609 Arguments :
10610 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10611 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10612 as explained at the top of this document.
10613
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010614 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10615 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10616 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10617 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010618
10619 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10620 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10621 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10622 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010623 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010624
10625 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10626
10627
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010628timeout tunnel <timeout>
10629 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10631 yes | no | yes | yes
10632 Arguments :
10633 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10634 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10635 as explained at the top of this document.
10636
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010637 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010638 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10639 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10640 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010641 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10642 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010643 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10644 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10645 specified.
10646
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010647 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10648 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10649 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10650 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10651 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10652 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10653 state.
10654
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010655 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10656 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10657 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10658 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010659 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010660
10661 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10662 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10663 forget about it.
10664
10665 Example :
10666 defaults http
10667 option http-server-close
10668 timeout connect 5s
10669 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010670 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010671 timeout server 30s
10672 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10673
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010674 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010675
10676
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010677transparent (deprecated)
10678 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010680 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010681 Arguments : none
10682
10683 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10684 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10685 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10686 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10687 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10688 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10689 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10690 appropriate server.
10691
10692 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10693
10694 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10695 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10696
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010697 See also: "option transparent"
10698
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010699unique-id-format <string>
10700 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10702 yes | yes | yes | no
10703 Arguments :
10704 <string> is a log-format string.
10705
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010706 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10707 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10708 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10709 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010710
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010711 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10712 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10713 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10714 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10715 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10716 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10717 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10718 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010719
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010720 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10721 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010722
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010723 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010724
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010725 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010726
10727 will generate:
10728
10729 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10730
10731 See also: "unique-id-header"
10732
10733unique-id-header <name>
10734 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10736 yes | yes | yes | no
10737 Arguments :
10738 <name> is the name of the header.
10739
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010740 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10741 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010742
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010743 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010744
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010745 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010746 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10747
10748 will generate:
10749
10750 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10751
10752 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010753
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010754use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010755 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10757 no | yes | yes | no
10758 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010759 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10760 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010761
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010762 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10763 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010764
10765 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10766 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10767 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010768 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010769 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010770 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10771 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010772
10773 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10774 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10775 assign the backend.
10776
10777 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10778 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10779 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10780 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10781 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10782 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10783
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010784 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010785 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010786 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10787 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10788 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10789
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010790 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10791 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10792 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10793 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10794 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10795 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10796 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10797 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10798 cannot be forced from the request.
10799
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010800 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010801 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10802 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10803
10804 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10805 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010806
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010807
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010808use-server <server> if <condition>
10809use-server <server> unless <condition>
10810 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10812 no | no | yes | yes
10813 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010814 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010815
10816 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10817
10818 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10819 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10820 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10821
10822 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10823 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10824 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10825 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10826 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10827 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10828 matches will assign the server.
10829
10830 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10831 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10832 with the next rules until one matches.
10833
10834 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10835 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10836 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10837 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10838
10839 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10840 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10841 stripped.
10842
10843 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10844 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10845 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10846 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10847
10848 Example :
10849 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10850 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10851 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10852 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10853 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10854 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010855 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010856 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10857 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10858
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010859 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010860
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010861
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100108625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010863--------------------------
10864
10865The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10866depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10867settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10868written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10869described in this section.
10870
10871
108725.1. Bind options
10873-----------------
10874
10875The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10876as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10877no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10878parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10879while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10880provided immediately after the setting name.
10881
10882The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10883
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010884accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10885 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10886 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10887 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10888 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10889 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10890 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10891 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10892 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10893 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010894 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10895 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10896 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010897
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010898accept-proxy
10899 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010900 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10901 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010902 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10903 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10904 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10905 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010906 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010907 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10908 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010909 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10910 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010911
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010912allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010913 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010914 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10915 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10916 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10917 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010918
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010919alpn <protocols>
10920 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10921 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10922 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10923 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10924 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010925 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10926 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10927 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10928 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10929 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10930 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10931 preference, like below :
10932
10933 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010934
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010935backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010936 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010937 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10938
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010939curves <curves>
10940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10941 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10942 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10943 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10944 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10945 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10946
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010947ecdhe <named curve>
10948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010949 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10950 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010951
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010952ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010953 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10954 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10955 client's certificate.
10956
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010957ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10958 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10959 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10960 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10961 error is ignored.
10962
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010963ca-sign-file <cafile>
10964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10965 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10966 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10967 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10968 'generate-certificates' for details.
10969
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010970ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10972 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10973 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10974 'generate-certificates' for details.
10975
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010976ciphers <ciphers>
10977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10978 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010979 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010980 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010981 information and recommendations see e.g.
10982 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10983 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10984 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10985
10986ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10987 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10988 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10989 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10990 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010991 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10992 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010993
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010994crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010995 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10996 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10997 to verify client's certificate.
10998
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010999crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011000 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11001 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11002 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11003 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11004 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11005 file.
11006
11007 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11008 are loaded.
11009
11010 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011011 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011012 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11013 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11014 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11015 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011016 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11017 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011018 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011019
11020 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11021 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11022 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11023 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011024 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11025 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011026
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011027 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011028
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011030 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011031 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11032 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011033 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11034 clients).
11035
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011036 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11037 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11038 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11039 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11040 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11041 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11042 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11043 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11044 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11045 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11046 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11047 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11048 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11049
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011050 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11051 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11052 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11053 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11054 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11055
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011056 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11057 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11058 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11059 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011060
11061 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11062 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11063 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11064 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11065 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11066 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11067 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11068 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11069 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11070
11071 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11072
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011073 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011074 a cert bundle.
11075
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011076 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011077 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11078 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11079 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11080 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11081 provide multi-cert support.
11082
11083 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11084
11085 Filename | CN | SAN
11086 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11087 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011088 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011089 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11090 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11091
11092 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11093 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11094 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11095 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011096 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11097 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11098 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011099
11100 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11101 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11102
11103 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11104 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11105 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11106
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011107crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011109 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011110 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011111 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011112
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011113crt-list <file>
11114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011115 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11116 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011117
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011118 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11119
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011120 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11121 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011122 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011123 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011124
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011125 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11126 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11127 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11128 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11129 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11130 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11131 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11132 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011133
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011134 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011135 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011136 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11137 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11138 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011139
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011140 crt-list file example:
11141 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011142 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011143 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011144 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011145
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011146defer-accept
11147 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11148 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11149 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011150 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011151 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11152 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11153 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11154 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11155 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11156 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11157 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11158
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011159expose-fd listeners
11160 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11161 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011162 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11163 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011164 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011165
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011166force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011167 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011168 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011169 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011170 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011171
11172force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011173 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011174 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011175 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011176
11177force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011178 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011179 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011180 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011181
11182force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011183 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011184 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011185 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011186
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011187force-tlsv13
11188 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11189 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011190 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011191
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011192generate-certificates
11193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11194 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11195 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11196 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11197 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11198 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11199 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11200 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11201 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11202 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11203 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11204
11205 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11206 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011207 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011208 certificate is used many times.
11209
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011210gid <gid>
11211 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11212 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11213 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11214 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11215 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11216
11217group <group>
11218 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11219 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11220 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11221 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11222 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11223
11224id <id>
11225 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11226 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11227 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11228 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11229
11230interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011231 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11232 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11233 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11234 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11235 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11236 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011237 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11238 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11239 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11240 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11241 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11242 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011243
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011244level <level>
11245 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11246 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11247 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011248 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011249 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11250 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11251 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011252 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011253 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011254 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011255 all counters).
11256
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011257severity-output <format>
11258 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11259 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11260 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11261 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11262 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11263 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11264 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11265 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11266 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11267 rfc5424 convention.
11268
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011269maxconn <maxconn>
11270 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11271 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11272 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11273 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11274 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11275 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11276 eat all memory.
11277
11278mode <mode>
11279 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11280 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11281 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11282 UNIX sockets.
11283
11284mss <maxseg>
11285 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11286 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11287 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11288 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11289 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11290 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11291 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11292 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11293 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11294 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11295 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11296
11297name <name>
11298 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11299 page.
11300
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011301namespace <name>
11302 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11303 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11304 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11305 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11306
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011307nice <nice>
11308 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11309 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11310 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11311 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11312 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11313 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11314 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11315 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11316 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11317 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11318 one for an RDP socket.
11319
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011320no-ca-names
11321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11322 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11323
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011324no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011326 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011327 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011328 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011329 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11330 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011331
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011332no-tls-tickets
11333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11334 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11335 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011336 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11337 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011338
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011339no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011340 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011341 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011342 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011343 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011344 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11345 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011346
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011347no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011349 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011350 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011351 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011352 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11353 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011354
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011355no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011357 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011358 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011359 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011360 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11361 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011362
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011363no-tlsv13
11364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11365 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11366 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11367 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011368 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11369 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011370
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011371npn <protocols>
11372 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11373 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11374 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11375 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011376 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011377 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11378 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11379 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11380 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11381 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011382
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011383prefer-client-ciphers
11384 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11385 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11386 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011387 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11388 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11389 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011390
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011391process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011392 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011393 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011394 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011395 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11396 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11397 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11398 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011399 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011400 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11401 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11402 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11403 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11404 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011405
11406 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11407
11408 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11409 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11410 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11411 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11412 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11413 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11414 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11415 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011416
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011417proto <name>
11418 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11419 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11420 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11421 in haproxy -vv.
11422 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11423 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011424 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011425 h2" on the bind line.
11426
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011427ssl
11428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011429 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011430 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11431 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011432 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11433 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011434
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011435ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11436 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11437 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11438 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11439
11440ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11441 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11442 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11443 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11444
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011445strict-sni
11446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11447 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11448 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11449 See the "crt" option for more information.
11450
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011451tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011452 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011453 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11454 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011455 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011456 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11457 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11458 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11459 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11460 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11461 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11462 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11463
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011464tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011465 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011466 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11467 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11468 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11469 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11470 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11471 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11472 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011473 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11474 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11475 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011476
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011477tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11478 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011479 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11480 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11481 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11482 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11483 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11484 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11485 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11486 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11487 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11488 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011489 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11490 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11491
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011492transparent
11493 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11494 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11495 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11496 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11497 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11498 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11499 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11500 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11501 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11502 so check for support with your vendor.
11503
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011504v4v6
11505 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11506 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11507 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11508 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011509 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011510
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011511v6only
11512 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11513 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11514 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011515 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11516 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011517
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011518uid <uid>
11519 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11520 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11521 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11522 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11523 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11524
11525user <user>
11526 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11527 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11528 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11529 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11530 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11531
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011532verify [none|optional|required]
11533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11534 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11535 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11536 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11537 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011538 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11539 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11540 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11541 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011542
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200115435.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011544------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011546The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11547which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11548arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11549settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11550after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11551Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11552address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011554 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011555 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011556
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011557Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11558keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011560The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011561
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011562addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011563 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011564 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11565 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11566 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11567 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11568 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011569
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011570agent-check
11571 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011572 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011573 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11574 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11575 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011576
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011577 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011578 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011579 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11580 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11581 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011582
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011583 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11584 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11585 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11586 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11587 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011588
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011589 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011590 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011591
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011592 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11593 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11594 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011595
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011596 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11597 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11598 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011599
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011600 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11601 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11602 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11603 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11604 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011605 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011606 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011607
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011608 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11609 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011610
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011611 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11612 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11613 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11614 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11615 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11616 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11617 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11618 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11619 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011620
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011621 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11622 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011623 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11624 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11625 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011626 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011627
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011628 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011629 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011630
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011631agent-send <string>
11632 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11633 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11634 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11635 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11636 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11637
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011638agent-inter <delay>
11639 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11640 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11641
11642 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11643 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11644 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11645 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11646 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11647 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11648 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11649 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11650 of backends use the same servers.
11651
11652 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11653
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011654agent-addr <addr>
11655 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11656
11657 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11658 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11659 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11660 hostname, it will be resolved.
11661
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011662agent-port <port>
11663 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11664
11665 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11666
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011667alpn <protocols>
11668 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11669 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11670 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11671 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11672 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11673 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11674 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11675 now obsolete NPN extension.
11676 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11677 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11678
11679 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011681backup
11682 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11683 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11684 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11685 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011686 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11687 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011688
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011689ca-file <cafile>
11690 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11691 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11692 server's certificate.
11693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011694check
11695 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011696 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11697 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11698 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11699 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11700 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11701 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11702 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011703 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11704 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011705 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11706 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011707
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011708check-send-proxy
11709 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11710 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11711 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11712 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11713 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11714 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11715 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11716
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011717check-alpn <protocols>
11718 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11719 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11720 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11721
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011722check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011723 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011724 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11725 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011726
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011727check-ssl
11728 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11729 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11730 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11731 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011732 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011733 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11734 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011735 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011736 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11737 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011738
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011739ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11741 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11742 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011743 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11744 information and recommendations see e.g.
11745 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11746 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11747 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011748
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011749ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11750 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11751 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11752 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11753 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011754 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11755 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11756 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011758cookie <value>
11759 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11760 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11761 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11762 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11763 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11764 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11765 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11766
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011767crl-file <crlfile>
11768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11769 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11770 to verify server's certificate.
11771
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011772crt <cert>
11773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11774 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11775 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11776 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11777 certificate request.
11778
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011779disabled
11780 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11781 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11782 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11783 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11784 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011785 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011786
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011787enabled
11788 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11789 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11790 default value.
11791 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11792 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011794error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011795 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11796 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11797 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011799 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011801fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011802 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11803 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11804 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11805
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011806force-sslv3
11807 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11808 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011809 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011810 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011811
11812force-tlsv10
11813 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011814 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011815 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011816
11817force-tlsv11
11818 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011819 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011820 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011821
11822force-tlsv12
11823 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011824 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011825 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011826
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011827force-tlsv13
11828 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11829 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011830 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011832id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011833 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11834 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11835 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011836
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011837init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11838 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11839 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011840 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011841 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11842 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11843 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11844 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11845 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11846 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11847 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11848 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11849 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011850 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011851 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11852 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11853 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11854 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11855 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11856 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011857 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011858
11859 Example:
11860 defaults
11861 # never fail on address resolution
11862 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011864inter <delay>
11865fastinter <delay>
11866downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011867 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11868 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11869 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11870 between checks depending on the server state :
11871
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011872 Server state | Interval used
11873 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11874 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11875 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11876 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11877 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11878 or yet unchecked. |
11879 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11880 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11881 | "inter" otherwise.
11882 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011884 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11885 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11886 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11887 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011888 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11889 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11890 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11891 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11892 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011894maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011895 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11896 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11897 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11898 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11899 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11900 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11901 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11902 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011904maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011905 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11906 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11907 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11908 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11909 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11910 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11911 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11912
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011913max-reuse <count>
11914 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11915 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11916 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11917 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11918 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11919 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11920 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11921 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011923minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011924 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11925 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11926 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11927 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11928 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11929 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011930 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011931 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011932
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011933namespace <name>
11934 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11935 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11936 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11937 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11938
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011939no-agent-check
11940 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11941 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11942 default value.
11943 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11944 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11945
11946no-backup
11947 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11948 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11949 default value.
11950 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11951 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11952
11953no-check
11954 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11955 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11956 default value.
11957 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11958 "default-server" "check" setting.
11959
11960no-check-ssl
11961 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11962 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11963 default value.
11964 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11965 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11966
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011967no-send-proxy
11968 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11969 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11970 default value.
11971 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11972 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11973
11974no-send-proxy-v2
11975 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11976 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11977 default value.
11978 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11979 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11980
11981no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11982 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11983 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11984 default value.
11985 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11986 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11987
11988no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11989 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11990 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11991 default value.
11992 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11993 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11994
11995no-ssl
11996 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11997 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11998 default value.
11999 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12000 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12001
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012002no-ssl-reuse
12003 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12004 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12005 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12006 and for paranoid users.
12007
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012008no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012009 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12010 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012011 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012012
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012013 Supported in default-server: No
12014
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012015no-tls-tickets
12016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12017 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12018 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012019 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12020 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012021 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012022
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012023no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012024 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012025 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12026 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012027 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12028 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012029 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012030
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012031 Supported in default-server: No
12032
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012033no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012034 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012035 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12036 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012037 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12038 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012039 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012040
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012041 Supported in default-server: No
12042
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012043no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012044 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012045 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12046 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012047 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12048 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012049 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012050
12051 Supported in default-server: No
12052
12053no-tlsv13
12054 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12055 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12056 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12057 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12058 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012059 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012060
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012061 Supported in default-server: No
12062
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012063no-verifyhost
12064 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12065 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12066 default value.
12067 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12068 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012069
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012070non-stick
12071 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12072 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12073 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12074
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012075npn <protocols>
12076 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12077 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12078 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12079 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12080 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12081 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12082 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012084observe <mode>
12085 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12086 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12087 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12088 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12089 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12090 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012091 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012092
12093 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012095on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012096 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12097 Currently, four modes are available:
12098 - fastinter: force fastinter
12099 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12100 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12101 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12102 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12103
12104 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12105
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012106on-marked-down <action>
12107 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12108 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012109 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12110 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12111 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12112 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12113 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12114 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12115 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12116 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012117
12118 Actions are disabled by default
12119
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012120on-marked-up <action>
12121 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12122 Currently one action is available:
12123 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12124 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12125 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12126 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012127 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12128 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012129 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12130 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12131
12132 Actions are disabled by default
12133
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012134pool-max-conn <max>
12135 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12136 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12137 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12138 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12139 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12140 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12141
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012142pool-purge-delay <delay>
12143 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012144 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12145 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012147port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012148 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12149 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12150 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12151 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12152 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12153 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12154
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012155proto <name>
12156
12157 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12158 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12159 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12160 reported in haproxy -vv.
12161 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12162 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012164redir <prefix>
12165 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12166 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12167 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12168 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12169 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12170 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12171 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12172 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012173 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012174 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012175 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12176 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12177 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12178 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12179
12180 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012182rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012183 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12184 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12185 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12186
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012187resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12188 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12189 server.
12190
12191 Available options:
12192
12193 * allow-dup-ip
12194 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12195 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12196 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12197 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12198 For such case, simply enable this option.
12199 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12200
12201 * prevent-dup-ip
12202 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12203 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12204 same fqdn.
12205 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12206
12207 Example:
12208 backend b_myapp
12209 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12210 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12211 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12212
12213 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12214 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12215 it
12216 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12217 different address
12218
12219 Default value: not set
12220
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012221resolve-prefer <family>
12222 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12223 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12224 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12225 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12226
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012227 Default value: ipv6
12228
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012229 Example:
12230
12231 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012232
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012233resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12234 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12235 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012236 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012237 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12238 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012239 configured network, another address is selected.
12240
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012241 Example:
12242
12243 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012244
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012245resolvers <id>
12246 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12247 hostname.
12248
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012249 Example:
12250
12251 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012252
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012253 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012254
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012255send-proxy
12256 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12257 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12258 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12259 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012260 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12261 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12262 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12263 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12264 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12265 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12266 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12267 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12268 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12269 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012270 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12271 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012272
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012273send-proxy-v2
12274 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12275 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12276 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12277 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012278 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12279 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12280 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12281 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012282
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012283proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12284 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12285 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012286 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12287 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012288 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12289 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012290 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012291
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012292send-proxy-v2-ssl
12293 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12294 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12295 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12296 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12297 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12298 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12299 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012300 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12301 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012302
12303send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12304 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12305 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12306 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12307 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12308 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12309 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12310 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12311 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012312 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12313 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012315slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012316 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12317 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12318 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12319 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12320 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12321 parameters :
12322
12323 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12324 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12325
12326 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12327 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12328 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12329 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12330
12331 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12332 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12333 seen as failed.
12334
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012335sni <expression>
12336 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12337 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12338 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12339 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012340 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12341 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012342 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012343 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12344 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012345
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012346source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012347source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012348source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012349 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12350 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12351 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12352 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12353
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012354 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12355 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12356 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12357 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12358 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12359 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12360 server.
12361
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012362 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12363 specifying the source address without port(s).
12364
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012365ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012366 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12367 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12368 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12369 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12370 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12371 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012372 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12373 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012374
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012375ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12376 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12377 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12378 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12379
12380ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12381 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12382 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12383 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12384
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012385ssl-reuse
12386 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12387 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12388 default value.
12389 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12390 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12391
12392stick
12393 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12394 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12395 default value.
12396 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12397 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012398
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012399tcp-ut <delay>
12400 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12401 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12402 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012403 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012404 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12405 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12406 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12407 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12408 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12409 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12410 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12411 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12412 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012414track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012415 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12416 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12417 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12418 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012419 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12420
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012421tls-tickets
12422 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12423 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12424 default value.
12425 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12426 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012427
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012428verify [none|required]
12429 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012430 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012431 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12432 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012433 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012434 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12435 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12436 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12437 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12438 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12439 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12440 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12441 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012442
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012443verifyhost <hostname>
12444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012445 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12446 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12447 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12448 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12449 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12450 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12451 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12452 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012454weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012455 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12456 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12457 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012458 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12459 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12460 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12461 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12462 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12463 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012464
12465
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124665.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12467-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012468
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012469HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12470using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12471configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012472This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12473can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12474workload.
12475This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12476resolution at run time.
12477Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12478carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12479
12480
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124815.3.1. Global overview
12482----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012483
12484As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12485different steps of the process life:
12486
12487 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12488 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12489 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12490
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012491 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12492 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012493
12494A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12495 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12496 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12497 resolution to know this new IP.
12498
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012499When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012500HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012501SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12502from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12503will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12504will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012505
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012506A few things important to notice:
12507 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12508 first valid response.
12509
12510 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12511 servers return an error.
12512
12513
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125145.3.2. The resolvers section
12515----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012516
12517This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012518HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12519contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012520
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012521When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12522uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12523is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12524answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12525
12526When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012527used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012528
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012529 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12530 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12531 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012532
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012533 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12534 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012535
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012536 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12537 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12538 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012539
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012540For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12541following scenarios are possible:
12542
12543 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12544 ignored
12545
12546 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12547 applied
12548
12549 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12550 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12551
12552 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12553 retries the query with a new type
12554
12555 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12556 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012557
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012558As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12559a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012560<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012561
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012562
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012563resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012564 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012565
12566A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12567
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012568accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012569 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012570 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012571 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12572 by RFC 6891)
12573
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012574 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12575
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012576nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12577 DNS server description:
12578 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12579 <ip> : IP address of the server
12580 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12581
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012582parse-resolv-conf
12583 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12584 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12585 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12586
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012587hold <status> <period>
12588 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12589 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012590 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012591 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012592 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12593 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12594 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12595
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012596 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012597
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012598resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012599 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12600 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12601 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12602
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012603resolve_retries <nb>
12604 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12605 giving up.
12606 Default value: 3
12607
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012608 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12609 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12610 type.
12611
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012612timeout <event> <time>
12613 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12614 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12615 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012616 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12617 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012618 Default value: 1s
12619 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012620 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012621 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012622 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12623 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12624
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012625 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012626
12627 resolvers mydns
12628 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12629 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012630 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012631 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012632 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012633 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012634 hold other 30s
12635 hold refused 30s
12636 hold nx 30s
12637 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012638 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012639 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012640
12641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126426. HTTP header manipulation
12643---------------------------
12644
12645In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12646response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12647request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12648which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012649against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012650
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012651If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12652to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12653but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12654HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12655stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12656because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12657a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12658still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012660This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12661in section 4.2 :
12662
12663 - reqadd <string>
12664 - reqallow <search>
12665 - reqiallow <search>
12666 - reqdel <search>
12667 - reqidel <search>
12668 - reqdeny <search>
12669 - reqideny <search>
12670 - reqpass <search>
12671 - reqipass <search>
12672 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12673 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12674 - reqtarpit <search>
12675 - reqitarpit <search>
12676 - rspadd <string>
12677 - rspdel <search>
12678 - rspidel <search>
12679 - rspdeny <search>
12680 - rspideny <search>
12681 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12682 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12683
12684With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12685is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12686parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12687prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12688Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12689
12690 \t for a tab
12691 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12692 \n for a new line (LF)
12693 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12694 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12695 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12696 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12697 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12698
12699The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12700portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12701above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12702regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
127039 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12704is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12705
12706The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12707after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12708
12709Notes related to these keywords :
12710---------------------------------
12711 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12712 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12713 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12714
12715 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12716 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12717 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12718
12719 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12720 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12721 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12722 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12723 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12724
12725 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12726 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12727 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12728 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12729 useless headers before adding new ones.
12730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012731 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012732 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12733
12734 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12735 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12736 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12737
12738 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12739 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012740 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012741
12742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127437. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12744----------------------------------
12745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012746HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12748The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12749these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12750but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12751data called patterns.
12752
12753
127547.1. ACL basics
12755---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012756
12757The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12758content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12759from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12760simple :
12761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012762 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012763 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12765 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12768adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012769
12770In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012772 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012773
12774This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12775Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12776and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012777an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12778conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12779as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12780are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012781
12782ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12783'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12784which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12785
12786There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12787performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012789The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12790specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12791this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012792methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12793ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794
12795Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12796 - boolean
12797 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12798 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12799 - string
12800 - data block
12801
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012802Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12803converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12804would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12805The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12806which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12807
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012808Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12809keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12810fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12811which are summarized in the table below :
12812
12813 +---------------------+-----------------+
12814 | Sample or converter | Default |
12815 | output type | matching method |
12816 +---------------------+-----------------+
12817 | boolean | bool |
12818 +---------------------+-----------------+
12819 | integer | int |
12820 +---------------------+-----------------+
12821 | ip | ip |
12822 +---------------------+-----------------+
12823 | string | str |
12824 +---------------------+-----------------+
12825 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12826 +---------------------+-----------------+
12827
12828Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12829matching method, see below.
12830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12832 - boolean
12833 - integer or integer range
12834 - IP address / network
12835 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12836 - regular expression
12837 - hex block
12838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012839The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12840
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012841 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12842 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012843 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012844 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012845 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012846 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012847 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012849The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12850read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12851if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12852lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12853will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12854beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12855a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12856lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12857exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12858
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012859The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12860parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12861ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12862a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12863check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12864
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012865The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12866socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12867file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012869Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12870loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12871
12872 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12873
12874In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12875the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12876case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12877as well.
12878
12879The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12880sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12881do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12882methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12883is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012884obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012885followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12886default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12887that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12888string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12889
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012890The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12891By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12892string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12893resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12894server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12895waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12896flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12897function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012899There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12900sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12901be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012902
12903 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12904 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012905 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12906 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12907 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12908 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012909
12910 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12911 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012912 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012913
12914 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012916
12917 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012919
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012920 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012921 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12922
12923 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12924 binary or string samples.
12925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012926 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12927 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012929 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12930 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12931 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012933 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12934 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012936 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12937 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012939 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12940 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012942 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12943 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012944 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12947 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12948 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012949
12950For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12951request, it is possible to do :
12952
12953 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12954
12955In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12956buffer, one would use the following acl :
12957
12958 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12959
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012960On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12961possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12962
12963 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012965All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12966criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12967method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12968to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12969criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12970the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012973the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12974For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012976 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12977 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12978 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12979 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012980
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012981
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012982The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12983types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12984combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12985brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12986default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012988 +-------------------------------------------------+
12989 | Input sample type |
12990 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012991 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012992 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12993 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12994 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012995 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012996 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012997 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012998 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012999 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013000 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013001 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013002 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013003 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013005 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013007 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013008 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013009 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013010 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013011 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013012 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013013 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013014 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013015 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13017 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13018 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013019
13020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130217.1.1. Matching booleans
13022------------------------
13023
13024In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13025Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13026When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13027that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13028
13029Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13030return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13031"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13032
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130347.1.2. Matching integers
13035------------------------
13036
13037Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13038enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13039to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13040
13041Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13042matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13043lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013044
13045For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13046unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13047representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13048
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013049As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13050two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13051instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13052ranges and operators.
13053
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013054For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013055operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13056Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13057of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013059Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013060
13061 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13062 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13063 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13064 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13065 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013067For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013068
13069 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13070
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013071This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13072
13073 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13074
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130767.1.3. Matching strings
13077-----------------------
13078
13079String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13080different forms :
13081
13082 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013083 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013084
13085 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013086 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013087
13088 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13089 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13090
13091 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13092 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13093
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013094 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13096 matches.
13097
13098 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13099 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13100 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013101
13102String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13103exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13104characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13105string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13106to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013107before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013108
13109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131107.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13111---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013112
13113Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13114they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13115possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13116passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13117the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013118the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13119match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013120
13121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131227.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13123-------------------------------------
13124
13125It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13126not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13127a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13128to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13129digits may be used upper or lower case.
13130
13131Example :
13132 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13133 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13134
13135
131367.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13137---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013138
13139IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13140netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13141within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013142host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013143difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13144at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13145does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13146parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013147
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013148The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13149abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13150
13151 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13152 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13153 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13154 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13155 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13156 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13157 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13158 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13159
13160Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13161192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13162
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013163IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13164Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13165trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13166IPv6 patterns.
13167
13168HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13169following situations :
13170 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13171 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13172 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13173 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13174 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13175 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13176 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13177 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13178 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13179 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181
131827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13183----------------------------------
13184
13185Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13186combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13187
13188 - AND (implicit)
13189 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13190 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013192A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013194 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013196Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13197indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013199For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13200"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13201requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13202is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13203
13204 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013205 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13206 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13207 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208
13209To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13210and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13211
13212 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13213 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13214 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13215 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13216
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013217 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013218 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13219 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13220 use_backend www if host_www
13221
13222It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13223expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13224be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13225the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13226
13227 The following rule :
13228
13229 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013230 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013231
13232 Can also be written that way :
13233
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013234 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013235
13236It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13237to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13238simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13239sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13240good use is the following :
13241
13242 With named ACLs :
13243
13244 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13245 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13246 monitor fail if site_dead
13247
13248 With anonymous ACLs :
13249
13250 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13251
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013252See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13253keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013254
13255
132567.3. Fetching samples
13257---------------------
13258
13259Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13260against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13261sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13262ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13263of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13264available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13265
13266This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13267Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13268compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13269deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13270
13271The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13272matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13273method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13274indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13275
13276As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13277when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13278mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13279the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13280ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13281
13282Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13283multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13284when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013285incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13286are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013287is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13288all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13289
13290Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13291 - name
13292 - name(arg1)
13293 - name(arg1,arg2)
13294
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013295
132967.3.1. Converters
13297-----------------
13298
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013299Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13300of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13301is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13302was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013303has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013304unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13305
13306These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13307sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13308the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013309support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013310
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013311A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13312support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13313supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13314(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13315bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013317The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013318
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001331951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13320 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13321 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13322 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13323 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13324 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13325
13326 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013327 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13328 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013329 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13330 frontend http-in
13331 bind *:8081
13332 default_backend servers
13333 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13334 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13335
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013336add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013337 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013338 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013339 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13340 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013341 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013342 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13343 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13344 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13345 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013346 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013347 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013348
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013349aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13350 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13351 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13352 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13353 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13354 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13355 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13356
13357 Example:
13358 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13359 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13360
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013361and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013362 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013363 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013364 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13365 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013366 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13370 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013371 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013372 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013373
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013374b64dec
13375 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13376 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13377
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013378base64
13379 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013380 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013381 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13382
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013383bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013384 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013385 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013386 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013387 presence of a flag).
13388
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013389bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13390 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13391 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013392 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013393
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013394concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13395 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13396 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13397 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13398 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13399 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13400 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13401 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13402 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13403 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13404 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13405 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13406 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13407 delimitors.
13408
13409 Example:
13410 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13411 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13412 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13413 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13414
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013415cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013416 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13417 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013418
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013419crc32([<avalanche>])
13420 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13421 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13422 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13423 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13424 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13425 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13426 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13427 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13428 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13429 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013430 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13431
13432crc32c([<avalanche>])
13433 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13434 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13435 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13436 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13437 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13438 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13439 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13440 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013441
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013442da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013443 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13444 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13445 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13446 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013447 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013448 configuration language.
13449
13450 Example:
13451 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013452 bind *:8881
13453 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013454 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013455
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013456debug
13457 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13458 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13459 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13460
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013461div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013462 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13463 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013464 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013465 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13466 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013467 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013468 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13469 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13470 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13471 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013472 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013473 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013474
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013475djb2([<avalanche>])
13476 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13477 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13478 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13479 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13480 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13481 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13482 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013483 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13484 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013485
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013486even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013487 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013488 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13489
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013490field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13491 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13492 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13493 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13494 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13495 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13496 fields.
13497
13498 Example :
13499 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13500 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13501 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13502 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13503 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013504
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013505hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013506 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013507 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013508 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013509 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013510
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013511hex2i
13512 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13513 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13514
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013515http_date([<offset>])
13516 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13517 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13518 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13519 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13520 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13521 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013522
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013523in_table(<table>)
13524 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13525 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13526 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013527 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013528 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13529
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013530ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13531 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013532 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013533 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13534 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13535 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13536 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13537 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013538
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013539json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013540 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013541 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013542 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013543 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13544 of errors:
13545 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13546 bytes, ...)
13547 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13548 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13549
13550 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13551 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13552 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13553 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13554 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13555 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013556 - "ascii" : never fails;
13557 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13558 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013559 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013560 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013561 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13562 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13563
13564 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013565 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013566
13567 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013568 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013569 capture request header user-agent len 150
13570 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013571
13572 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13573 GET / HTTP/1.0
13574 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13575
13576 Output log:
13577 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13578
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013579language(<value>[,<default>])
13580 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13581 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13582 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13583 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13584 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13585 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13586 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13587 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13588 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013589 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013590 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13591 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013593 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013594
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013595 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13596 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013597
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013598 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13599 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13600 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13601 use_backend spanish if es
13602 use_backend french if fr
13603 use_backend english if en
13604 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013605
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013606length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013607 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13608 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13609 type. The result is of type integer.
13610
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013611lower
13612 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13613 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13614 type. The result is of type string.
13615
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013616ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13617 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13618 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13619 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13620 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13621 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13622 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13623
13624 Example :
13625
13626 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013627 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013628 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013630map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13631map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13632map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13633 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13634 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13635 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13636 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13637 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13638 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13639 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13640 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013641
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013642 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13643 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13644 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013645
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013646 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013647 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013648
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013649 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13650 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13651 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13652 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013653 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13654 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013655 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13656 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13657 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13658 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13659 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13660 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13661 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13662 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013663 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13664 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13665 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013666 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13667 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13668 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13669 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13670 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013671
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013672 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13673 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13674 the corresponding match text.
13675
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013676 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13677 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13678 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13679 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13680 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013681
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013682 Example :
13683
13684 # this is a comment and is ignored
13685 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13686 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13687 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13688 | | | `---------- value
13689 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13690 | `---------------------------- key
13691 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13692
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013693mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013694 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13695 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013696 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013697 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013698 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013699 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13700 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13701 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13702 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013703 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013704 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013705
13706mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013707 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013708 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13709 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013710 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013711 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013712 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013713 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13714 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13715 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13716 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013717 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013718 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013719
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013720nbsrv
13721 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13722 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13723 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13724 map lookup.
13725
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013726neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013727 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13728 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13729 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13730 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013731
13732not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013733 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013734 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013735 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013736 absence of a flag).
13737
13738odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013739 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013740 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13741
13742or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013743 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013744 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013745 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13746 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013747 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013748 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13749 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13750 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13751 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013753 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013754
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013755protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13756 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13757 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13758 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13759 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13760 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13761 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13762 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13763 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13764 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13765 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13766 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13767
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013768regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013769 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13770 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13771 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13772 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13773 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13774 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13775 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13776 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13777 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13778 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013779 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13780 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13781 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13782 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013783
13784 Example :
13785
13786 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13787 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13788 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13789 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13790
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013791capture-req(<id>)
13792 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13793 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13794
13795 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013796 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13797 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013798
13799capture-res(<id>)
13800 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13801 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13802
13803 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013804 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13805 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013806
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013807sdbm([<avalanche>])
13808 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13809 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13810 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13811 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13812 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13813 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13814 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013815 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13816 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013817
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013818set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013819 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13820 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13821 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013822 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013823 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13824 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013825 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013826 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13827 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013828 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013829 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013830
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013831sha1
13832 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13833 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13834
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013835strcmp(<var>)
13836 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13837 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13838 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13839 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13840 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13841 shorter).
13842
13843 Example :
13844
13845 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13846 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13847 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13848
13849
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013850sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013851 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13852 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013853 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013854 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13855 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013856 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013857 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13858 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013859 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013860 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13861 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013863 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013864
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013865table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13869 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13870 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13871 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13872
13873
13874table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13878 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13879 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13880 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13881
13882table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013885 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013886 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13887 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13888
13889table_conn_cur(<table>)
13890 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13891 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13892 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13893 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13894 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13895
13896table_conn_rate(<table>)
13897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13900 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13901 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13902
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013903table_gpt0(<table>)
13904 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13905 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13906 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13907 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13908 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13909
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013910table_gpc0(<table>)
13911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13914 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13915 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13916
13917table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13918 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13919 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13920 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13921 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13922 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13923 sample fetch keyword.
13924
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013925table_gpc1(<table>)
13926 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13927 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13928 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13929 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13930 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13931
13932table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13933 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13934 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13935 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13936 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13937 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13938 sample fetch keyword.
13939
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013940table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13941 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13942 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013943 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013944 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13945 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13946
13947table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13950 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13951 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13952 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13953 keyword.
13954
13955table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13956 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13957 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013958 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013959 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13960 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13961
13962table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13963 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13964 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13965 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13966 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13967 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13968 keyword.
13969
13970table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13971 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13972 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013973 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013974 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13975 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13976 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13977 keyword.
13978
13979table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13980 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13981 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013982 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013983 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13984 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13985 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13986 keyword.
13987
13988table_server_id(<table>)
13989 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13990 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13991 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13992 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13993 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13994 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13995
13996table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013999 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014000 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14001 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14002 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14003 keyword.
14004
14005table_sess_rate(<table>)
14006 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14007 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14008 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14009 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14010 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14011 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14012 keyword.
14013
14014table_trackers(<table>)
14015 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14016 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14017 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14018 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14019 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14020 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14021 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14022 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14023 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14024 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14025
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014026upper
14027 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14028 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14029 type. The result is of type string.
14030
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014031url_dec
14032 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14033 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14034
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014035ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014036 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014037 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14038 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14039 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014040 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14041 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14042 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14043 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014044 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014045 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14046 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014047
14048 Example:
14049 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14050 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14051
14052 message Point {
14053 int32 latitude = 1;
14054 int32 longitude = 2;
14055 }
14056
14057 message PPoint {
14058 Point point = 59;
14059 }
14060
14061 message Rectangle {
14062 // One corner of the rectangle.
14063 PPoint lo = 48;
14064 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14065 PPoint hi = 49;
14066 }
14067
14068 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14069 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14070 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14071
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014072 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14073 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14074 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14075 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14076
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014077 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014078
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014079 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014080
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014081 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14082 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14083 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14084
14085 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14086 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14087 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14088
14089 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14090 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14091 interpret the previous binary sample.
14092
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014093
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014094unset-var(<var name>)
14095 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14096 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14097 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14098 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14099 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14100 response),
14101 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14102 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14103 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14104 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14105
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014106utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14107 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14108 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14109 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14110 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14111 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14112 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14113
14114 Example :
14115
14116 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014117 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014118 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14119
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014120word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14121 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14122 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14123 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14124 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14125 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14126
14127 Example :
14128 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14129 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14130 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14131 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14132 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014133
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014134wt6([<avalanche>])
14135 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14136 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14137 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14138 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14139 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14140 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14141 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014142 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14143 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014144
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014145xor(<value>)
14146 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014147 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014148 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014149 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014150 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014151 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14152 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014153 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014154 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14155 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014156 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014157 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014158
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014159xxh32([<seed>])
14160 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14161 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14162 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14163 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14164 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14165 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14166 as cryptographically secure.
14167
14168xxh64([<seed>])
14169 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14170 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14171 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14172 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14173 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14174 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14175 as cryptographically secure.
14176
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014177
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014179--------------------------------------------
14180
14181A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14182not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14183"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14184The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14185
14186always_false : boolean
14187 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14188 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14189
14190always_true : boolean
14191 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14192 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14193
14194avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014195 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014196 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14197 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14198 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14199 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14200 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14201 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14202 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14203 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14204 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14205 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14206 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14207 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14208 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014211 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14212 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14213 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14214 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014215 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14216
14217be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14218 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14219 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14220 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14221 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14222 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014223 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14224 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014225
14226 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14227 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14228 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014230be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14231 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14232 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14233 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014234 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14236 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014237
14238 Example :
14239 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14240 backend dynamic
14241 mode http
14242 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14243 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014245bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014246 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14247 of the string.
14248
14249bool(<bool>) : bool
14250 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14251 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14254 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014255 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014256 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14257 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014258
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014259 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014260 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014261 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14262
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014263 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14264 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014265
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014266 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014267 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014269 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014270 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014271 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014272 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014273
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014274 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14275 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014276 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014277 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014278
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014279cpu_calls : integer
14280 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14281 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14282 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14283 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14284 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14285 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14286
14287cpu_ns_avg : integer
14288 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14289 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14290 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14291 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14292 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14293 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14294 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14295 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14296 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14297 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14298 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14299
14300cpu_ns_tot : integer
14301 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14302 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14303 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14304 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14305 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14306 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14307 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14308 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14309 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14310 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14311 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14312 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14313 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14314
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014315date([<offset>]) : integer
14316 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14317 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14318 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14319 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014320 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14321
14322 Example :
14323
14324 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14325 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014326
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014327date_us : integer
14328 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14329 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14330 from the same timeval structure.
14331
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014332distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14333 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14334 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14335 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14336 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14337 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14338 list of supported tokens.
14339
14340distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14341 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14342 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14343 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14344 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14345 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14346 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14347 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14348 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14349 supported tokens.
14350
14351 Example :
14352 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14353 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14354 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14355 # send large files to the big farm
14356 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14357
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014358env(<name>) : string
14359 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14360 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14361 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14362 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14363 certain way.
14364
14365 Examples :
14366 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14367 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14368
14369 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14370 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014372fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14373 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014374 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14375 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014376 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14377 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014378 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014379 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14380 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014381
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014382fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14383 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14384 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14385 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014387fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14388 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14389 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14390 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14391 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14392 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14393 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14394 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14395 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014396
14397 Example :
14398 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14399 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14400 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14401 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14402 frontend mail
14403 bind :25
14404 mode tcp
14405 maxconn 100
14406 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14407 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14408 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14409 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014410
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014411hostname : string
14412 Returns the system hostname.
14413
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014414int(<integer>) : signed integer
14415 Returns a signed integer.
14416
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014417ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14418 Returns an ipv4.
14419
14420ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14421 Returns an ipv6.
14422
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014423lat_ns_avg : integer
14424 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14425 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14426 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14427 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14428 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14429 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14430 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14431 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14432 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14433 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14434 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14435 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14436 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14437 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14438
14439lat_ns_tot : integer
14440 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14441 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14442 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14443 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14444 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14445 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14446 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14447 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14448 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14449 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14450 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14451 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14452 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14453 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14454 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14455 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14456 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14457 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14458 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14459
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014460meth(<method>) : method
14461 Returns a method.
14462
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014463nbproc : integer
14464 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14465 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14466 and debugging purposes.
14467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014468nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14469 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14470 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14471 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014472 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14473 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14474 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014475
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014476prio_class : integer
14477 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14478 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14479 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14480
14481prio_offset : integer
14482 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14483 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14484 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14485 set-priority-offset".
14486
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014487proc : integer
14488 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14489 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14490 debugging purposes.
14491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014492queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014493 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14494 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14495 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14497 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14498 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14499 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14500 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14501
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014502rand([<range>]) : integer
14503 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14504 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14505 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14506 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14507 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14510 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14511 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14512 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14513 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14514 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014515 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14516 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14517
14518srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14519 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14520 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14521 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14522 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14523 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14524 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14525 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14526
14527 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14528 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014529
14530srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14531 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14532 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14533 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014534 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14536 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14537 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14538
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014539srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14540 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14541 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14542 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14543 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14544 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14545 fetch methods.
14546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014547srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14548 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14549 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014550 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014551 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14552 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014553 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014554 overloading servers).
14555
14556 Example :
14557 # Redirect to a separate back
14558 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14559 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14560 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14561
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014562stopping : boolean
14563 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14564 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14565 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14566
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014567str(<string>) : string
14568 Returns a string.
14569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014570table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14571 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14572 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14573
14574table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14575 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14576 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14577 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14578
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014579thread : integer
14580 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14581 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14582 and debugging purposes.
14583
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014584var(<var-name>) : undefined
14585 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014586 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14587 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014588 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014589 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14590 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014591 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014592 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14593 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014594 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014595 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014596
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145977.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014598----------------------------------
14599
14600The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14601closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14602methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14603sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14604TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014605the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14606counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014607"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14608used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14609can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14610Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14611table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14612tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14613currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014614
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014615bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014616 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14617 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14618 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014620be_id : integer
14621 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14622 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14623
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014624be_name : string
14625 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14626 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014628dst : ip
14629 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14630 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14631 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14632 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014633 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14634 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14635 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14636 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14637 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14638 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014639
14640dst_conn : integer
14641 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14642 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14643 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14644 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14645 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14646 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14647 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14648 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014649
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014650dst_is_local : boolean
14651 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14652 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14653 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14654 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014655 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014656 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14657 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14658 it only once per connection.
14659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014660dst_port : integer
14661 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14662 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14663 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14664 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14665 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14666 an HTTP header.
14667
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014668fc_http_major : integer
14669 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14670 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14671 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14672
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014673fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14674 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14675 header.
14676
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014677fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14678 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14679 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14680 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14681 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14682 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14683 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14684
14685fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14686 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14687 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14688 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14689 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14690 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14691 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14692
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014693fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14694 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14695 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14696 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14697 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14698
14699fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14700 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14701 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14702 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14703 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14704
14705fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14706 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14707 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14708 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14709 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14710
14711fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14712 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14713 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14714 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14715 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14716
14717fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14718 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14719 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14720 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14721 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14722
14723fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14724 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14725 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14726 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14727 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14728
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014729fe_defbe : string
14730 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14731 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014733fe_id : integer
14734 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014735 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014736 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14737
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014738fe_name : string
14739 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14740 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14741 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014743sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014744sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14745sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14746sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014747 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14748 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14749 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14750
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014751sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014752sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14753sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14754sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014755 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14756 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14757 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014759sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014760sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14761sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14762sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014763 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14764 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014765 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14766 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14767 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014768
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014769 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014770 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14771 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014772 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14773 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14774 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014775 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14776 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14777
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014778sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14779sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14780sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14781sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14782 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14783 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14784 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14785 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14786 when a first ACL was verified.
14787
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014788sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014789sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14790sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14791sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014792 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014793 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14794
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014795sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014796sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14797sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14798sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014799 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14800 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14801 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14802
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014803sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014804sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14805sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14806sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014807 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14808 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14809 See also src_conn_rate.
14810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014811sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014812sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14813sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14814sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014815 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014816 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014817
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014818sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14819sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14820sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14821sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14822 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14823 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14824
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014825sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14826sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14827sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14828sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14829 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14830 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14831
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014832sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014833sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14834sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14835sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014836 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14837 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14838 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014839 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14840 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14841 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014842
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014843sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14844sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14845sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14846sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14847 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14848 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14849 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14850 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14851 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14852 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14853
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014854sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014855sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14856sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14857sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014858 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014859 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14860 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014862sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014863sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14864sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14865sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014866 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14867 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14868 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14869 src_http_err_rate.
14870
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014871sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014872sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14873sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14874sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014875 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014876 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14877 src_http_req_cnt.
14878
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014879sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014880sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14881sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14882sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014883 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14884 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14885 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14886 src_http_req_rate.
14887
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014888sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014889sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14890sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14891sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014892 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014893 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14894 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14895 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14896 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014897
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014898 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014899 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14900 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014901 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14902
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014903sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14904sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14905sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14906sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14907 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14908 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14909 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14910 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14911 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014913sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014914sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14915sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14916sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014917 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14918 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14919 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014920
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014921sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014922sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14923sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14924sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014925 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14926 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14927 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014928
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014929sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014930sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14931sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14932sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014933 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014934 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14935 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14936 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014937 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014938 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14939
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014940sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014941sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14942sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14943sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014944 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14945 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14946 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14947 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14948 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014949 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014950
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014951sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014952sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14953sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14954sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014955 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14956 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14957 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14958
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014959sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014960sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14961sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14962sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014963 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14964 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014965 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014966 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14967 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14969 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14970 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972so_id : integer
14973 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14974 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14975 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014977src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014978 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14980 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14981 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014982 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14983 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14984 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014985 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14986 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14987 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14988 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14989 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14990 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14991 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014992
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014993 Example:
14994 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14995 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014997src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14998 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14999 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15000 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015001 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15004 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15005 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015006 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015007 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015009src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15010 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15011 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15012 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15013 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15014 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15015 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015016
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015017 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015018 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15019 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15020 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15021 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015022 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015023 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15024 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15025
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015026src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15027 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15028 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15029 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15030 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15031 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15032 was verified.
15033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015034src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015035 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015036 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015037 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015038 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015040src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015041 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015042 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15043 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015044 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15047 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15048 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15049 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015050 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015052src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015053 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015054 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015055 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015056 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015057
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015058src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15059 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15060 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15061 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15062 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15063
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015064src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15065 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15066 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15067 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15068 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015070src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015071 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015073 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15074 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015075 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15076 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15077 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015078
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015079src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15080 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15081 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15082 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15083 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15084 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15085 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15086 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015089 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015091 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015092 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15096 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15097 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15098 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15099 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015100 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015103 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15105 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015106 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015108src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15109 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15110 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15111 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015112 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015113 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015115src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15116 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15117 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15118 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015119 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015120 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15121 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015122
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015123 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015124 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015125 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015126 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015127
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015128src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15129 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15130 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15131 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15132 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15133 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15134 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15135
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015136src_is_local : boolean
15137 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15138 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15139 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15140 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015141 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015142 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15143 once per connection.
15144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015145src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015146 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15147 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15148 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15149 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15150 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015153 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15154 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15155 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15156 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15157 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015159src_port : integer
15160 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15161 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15162 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15163 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015165src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015166 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015167 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15168 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15169 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015170 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015172src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15173 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15174 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15175 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15176 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015177 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015179src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15180 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15181 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15182 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15183 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15184 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15185 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15186 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15187 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015188
15189 Example :
15190 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15191 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15192 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15193 listen ssh
15194 bind :22
15195 mode tcp
15196 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015197 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015198 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015199 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015201srv_id : integer
15202 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15203 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15204 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015205
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152067.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15210closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15211when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15212usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015213future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015214
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001521551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15216 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15217 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15218 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15219 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15220 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15221
15222 Example :
15223 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15224 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15225 # the request.
15226 frontend http-in
15227 bind *:8081
15228 default_backend servers
15229 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15230 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15231
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015232ssl_bc : boolean
15233 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15234 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15235 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15236
15237ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15238 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15239 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15240
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015241ssl_bc_alpn : string
15242 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15243 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15244 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15245 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15246 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15247 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15248 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15249 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15250 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15251
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015252ssl_bc_cipher : string
15253 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15254 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15255
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015256ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15257 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15258 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15259 session or a TLS ticket.
15260
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015261ssl_bc_npn : string
15262 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15263 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15264 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15265 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15266 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15267 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15268 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15269 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15270
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015271ssl_bc_protocol : string
15272 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15273 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15274
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015275ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015276 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015277 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15278 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015279
15280ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15281 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15282 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15283 if session was reused or not.
15284
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015285ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15286 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15287 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15288 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15289 BoringSSL.
15290
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015291ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15292 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15293 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15296 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15297 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15298 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15299 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15300 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015302ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15303 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15304 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15305 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15306 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015307
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015308ssl_c_der : binary
15309 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15310 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15311 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313ssl_c_err : integer
15314 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15315 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15316 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15317 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15318 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15321 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15322 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15323 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15324 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15325 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15326 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15327 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15328 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015330ssl_c_key_alg : string
15331 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15332 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15333 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335ssl_c_notafter : string
15336 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15337 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15338 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340ssl_c_notbefore : string
15341 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15342 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15343 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015345ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15346 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15347 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15348 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15349 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15350 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15351 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15352 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15353 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015355ssl_c_serial : binary
15356 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15357 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15358 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015360ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15361 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15362 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15363 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015364 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15365 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15366
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015367 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015368 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015370ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15371 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15372 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15373 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375ssl_c_used : boolean
15376 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15377 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015379ssl_c_verify : integer
15380 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15381 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15382 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15383 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015385ssl_c_version : integer
15386 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15387 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015388
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015389ssl_f_der : binary
15390 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15391 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15392 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15395 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15396 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15397 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15398 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015399 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015400 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15401 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15402 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015404ssl_f_key_alg : string
15405 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15406 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15407 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409ssl_f_notafter : string
15410 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15411 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15412 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015414ssl_f_notbefore : string
15415 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15416 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15417 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15420 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15421 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15422 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15423 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15424 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15425 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15426 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15427 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429ssl_f_serial : binary
15430 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15431 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15432 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015433
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015434ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15435 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15436 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15437 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15440 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15441 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15442 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015444ssl_f_version : integer
15445 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15446 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15447
15448ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015449 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15450 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15451 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015453 Example :
15454 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15455 listen http-https
15456 bind :80
15457 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15458 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15459
15460ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15461 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15462 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15463
15464ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015465 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15467 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15468 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15469 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15470 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15471 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15472 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15473 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015475ssl_fc_cipher : string
15476 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15477 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015478
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015479ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15480 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15481 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015482 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015483
15484ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15485 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15486 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015487 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015488
15489ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15490 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15491 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15492 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015493 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015494 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015495
15496ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15497 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15498 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015499 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015502 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15503 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015504 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15505 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15506 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15507 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015508
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015509ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15510 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15511 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15512 wait until the handshake happened.
15513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15515 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015516 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15517 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15518 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15519 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015520
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015521ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015522 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015523 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15524 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015526ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015527 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015528 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15529 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15530 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15531 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15532 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15533 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15534 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015536ssl_fc_protocol : string
15537 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15538 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015539
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015540ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015541 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015542 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15543 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15546 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15547 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15548 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15549 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015550
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015551ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15552 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15553 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15554 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15555 BoringSSL.
15556
15557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558ssl_fc_sni : string
15559 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15560 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15561 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15562 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15563 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15564
15565 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15566 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15567 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015568 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15569 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15573 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15576 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15577 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015578
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015579
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155807.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15584sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15585only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15586For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15587be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15588can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15589sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15590for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15591content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015594 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15596 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15599 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015600 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015602
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015603req.hdrs : string
15604 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15605 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15606 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15607 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15608
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015609req.hdrs_bin : binary
15610 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15611 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15612 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15613 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15614 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15615 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15616
15617 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15618
15619 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15620 str: <int:length><bytes>
15621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622req.len : integer
15623req_len : integer (deprecated)
15624 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15625 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15626 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15627 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15628 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15629 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15630 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15631 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15634 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015635 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15636 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15637 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15638 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640 ACL alternatives :
15641 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15644 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15645 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15646 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15647 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 ACL alternatives :
15650 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654req.proto_http : boolean
15655req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15656 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15657 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15658 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15659 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15660 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15661 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15662 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664 Example:
15665 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15666 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15667 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015668 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15671rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15672 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15673 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15674 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15675 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15676 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15677 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15678 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15681 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15682 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15683 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15684 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15685 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687 ACL derivatives :
15688 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690 Example :
15691 listen tse-farm
15692 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15693 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15694 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15695 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15696 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15697 persist rdp-cookie
15698 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15699 # This is only useful makes sense if
15700 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15701 stick-table type string size 204800
15702 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15703 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15704 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15707 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15710rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15711 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15712 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15713 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15714 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716 ACL derivatives :
15717 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015718
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015719req.ssl_alpn : string
15720 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15721 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15722 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15723 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15724 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15725 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015726 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015727
15728 Examples :
15729 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15730 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15731 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015732 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015733 default_backend bk_default
15734
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015735req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15736 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15737 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015738 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15739 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15740 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15741 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15742 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15745req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15746 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15747 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15748 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15749 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15750 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15751 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15752 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754req.ssl_sni : string
15755req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15756 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15757 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15758 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15759 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15760 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15761 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15762 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15763 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15764 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15765 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15766 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15767 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769 ACL derivatives :
15770 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772 Examples :
15773 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15774 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15775 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15776 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15777 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015778
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015779req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15780 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15781 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15782 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15783 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15784 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15785 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15786 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15787 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15788 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790req.ssl_ver : integer
15791req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15792 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15793 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15794 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15795 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15796 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15797 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15798 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015799 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802 ACL derivatives :
15803 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015804
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015805res.len : integer
15806 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15807 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15808 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15809 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15810 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15811 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15812 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15813 content inspection.
15814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015815res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15816 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015817 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15818 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15819 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15820 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15823 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15824 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15825 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15826 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015829
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015830res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15831rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15832 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15833 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15834 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15835 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15836 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15837 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15838 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840wait_end : boolean
15841 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15842 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015843 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15845 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015846 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015847 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15848 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850 Examples :
15851 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15852 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15853 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15856 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15857 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15858 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15859 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15860 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15861 tcp-request content reject
15862
15863
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158647.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865--------------------------------------
15866
15867It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15868This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15869data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15870its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15871HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15872content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15873to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15874more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15875response are indexed.
15876
15877base : string
15878 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15879 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15880 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15881 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15882 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15883 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15884 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15885 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15886
15887 ACL derivatives :
15888 base : exact string match
15889 base_beg : prefix match
15890 base_dir : subdir match
15891 base_dom : domain match
15892 base_end : suffix match
15893 base_len : length match
15894 base_reg : regex match
15895 base_sub : substring match
15896
15897base32 : integer
15898 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15899 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15900 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015901 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15902 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15903 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904
15905base32+src : binary
15906 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15907 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15908 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15909 per-URL counters.
15910
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015911capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15912 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15913 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15914 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15915
15916capture.req.method : string
15917 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15918 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15919 because it's allocated.
15920
15921capture.req.uri : string
15922 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15923 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15924 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15925 allocated.
15926
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015927capture.req.ver : string
15928 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15929 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15930 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15931
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015932capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15933 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15934 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15935 The first entry is an index of 0.
15936 See also: "capture response header"
15937
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015938capture.res.ver : string
15939 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15940 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15941 persistent flag.
15942
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015943req.body : binary
15944 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15945 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15946 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15947 the first chunk is analyzed.
15948
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015949req.body_param([<name>) : string
15950 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15951 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15952 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15953 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15954 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15955 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15956 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15957 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15958 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15959 given.
15960
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015961req.body_len : integer
15962 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15963 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15964 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15965 "option http-buffer-request".
15966
15967req.body_size : integer
15968 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15969 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15970 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15971 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15972 "option http-buffer-request".
15973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974req.cook([<name>]) : string
15975cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15976 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15977 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15978 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15979 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15980 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15981 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15982 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15983 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15984
15985 ACL derivatives :
15986 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15987 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15988 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15989 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15990 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15991 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15992 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15993 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015995req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15996cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15997 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15998 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016000req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16001cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16002 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16003 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16004 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16005 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16008 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16009 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16010 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16011 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016012 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016013 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16014 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16015 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16016 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16019 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16020 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16021 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16022 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016023 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016025req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16026 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16027 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16028 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16029 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16030 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16031 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16032 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16033 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16036 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16037 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16038 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16039 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16042 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16043 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16044 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16045 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16046 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16047 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16048 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16049 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016050 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016051 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016052 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054 ACL derivatives :
16055 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16056 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16057 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16058 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16059 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16060 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16061 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16062 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16063
16064req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16065hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16066 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16067 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16068 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16069 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16070 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16071 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16072 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16073 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16074 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16075
16076req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16077hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16078 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16079 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16080 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16081 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16082 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016083 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16085 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16086
16087req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16088hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16089 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16090 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16091 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16092 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16093 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16094 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16095 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16096
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016097
16098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016099http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16100 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16101 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16102 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16103 basic auth is supported.
16104
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016105http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16106 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16107 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16108 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16109 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016110 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16111 basic auth is supported.
16112
16113 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016114 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16115 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16116 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16117 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118
16119http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016120 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16121 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16123 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016125method : integer + string
16126 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16127 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16128 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16129 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16130 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16131 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16132 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134 ACL derivatives :
16135 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016137 Example :
16138 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16139 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16140 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016142path : string
16143 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16144 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16145 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16146 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16147 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016148 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016149 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151 ACL derivatives :
16152 path : exact string match
16153 path_beg : prefix match
16154 path_dir : subdir match
16155 path_dom : domain match
16156 path_end : suffix match
16157 path_len : length match
16158 path_reg : regex match
16159 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016160
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016161query : string
16162 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16163 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16164 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16165 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016166 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016167 which stops before the question mark.
16168
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016169req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16170 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16171 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16172 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16173 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175req.ver : string
16176req_ver : string (deprecated)
16177 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16178 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16179 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181 ACL derivatives :
16182 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016184res.comp : boolean
16185 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16186 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16187 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189res.comp_algo : string
16190 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16191 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16192 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194res.cook([<name>]) : string
16195scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16196 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16197 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16198 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200 ACL derivatives :
16201 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16204scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16205 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16206 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16207 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16210scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16211 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16212 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16213 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16216 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16217 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16218 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16219 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16220 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16221 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16222 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16223 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16224 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16227 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16228 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16229 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16230 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16231 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016233res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16234shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16235 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16236 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16237 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16238 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16239 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16240 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16241 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16242 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016244 ACL derivatives :
16245 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16246 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16247 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16248 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16249 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16250 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16251 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16252 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16253
16254res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16255shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16256 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16257 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16258 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16259 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16260 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016262res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16263shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16264 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16265 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16266 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16267 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16268 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16269 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016270
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016271res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16272 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16273 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16274 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16275 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016277res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16278shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16279 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16280 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16281 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16282 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16283 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16284 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286res.ver : string
16287resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16288 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16289 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016291 ACL derivatives :
16292 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016294set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16295 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16296 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016297 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016298 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16301 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303status : integer
16304 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16305 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16306 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016307
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016308unique-id : string
16309 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16310 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16311 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16312 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16313 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16314 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316url : string
16317 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16318 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16319 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16320 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16321 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16322 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16323 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016325 ACL derivatives :
16326 url : exact string match
16327 url_beg : prefix match
16328 url_dir : subdir match
16329 url_dom : domain match
16330 url_end : suffix match
16331 url_len : length match
16332 url_reg : regex match
16333 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016335url_ip : ip
16336 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16337 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16338 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16339 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16340 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16341 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16342 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344url_port : integer
16345 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16346 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16347 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16348 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016349
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016350urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16351url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16353 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016354 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16355 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16356 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16357 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016358 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16359 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016360 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16361 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363 ACL derivatives :
16364 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16365 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16366 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16367 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16368 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16369 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16370 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16371 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016372
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374 Example :
16375 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16376 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16377 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16378 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016379
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016380urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016381 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16382 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16383 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016384
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016385url32 : integer
16386 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16387 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16388 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16389 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16390 is an unsigned integer.
16391
16392url32+src : binary
16393 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16394 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16395 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16396
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163987.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016399---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016401Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16402every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016403order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016405ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16406---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016407FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016408HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016409HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16410HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016411HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16412HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16413HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16414HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16415LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016416METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016417METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016418METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16419METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16420METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16421METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016422METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016423METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016424RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016425REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016426TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016427WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16428---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016429
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164318. Logging
16432----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016433
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016434One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16435provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16436very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16437provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16438state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016439to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016440headers.
16441
16442In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16443about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16444send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16445
16446 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16447 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16448 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16449 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16450 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016451 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016452 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016453
16454The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16455allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16456as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16457while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16458real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16459delay.
16460
16461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164628.1. Log levels
16463---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016464
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016465TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016466source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016467HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16468in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16469track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16470syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16471about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016472
16473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164748.2. Log formats
16475----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016476
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016477HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016478and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16479slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16480options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016481
16482 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16483 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16484 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16485 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16486 extents.
16487
16488 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16489 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16490 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16491 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16492 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16493
16494 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16495 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16496 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16497 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16498 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16499
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016500 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16501 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16502 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16503 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16504
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016505 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16506
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016507Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16508specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16509field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16510servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16511always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16512identifier.
16513
16514Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16515 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16516 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16517 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16518 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16519
16520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165218.2.1. Default log format
16522-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016523
16524This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16525as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16526format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16527
16528 Example :
16529 listen www
16530 mode http
16531 log global
16532 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16533
16534 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16535 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16536 (www/HTTP)
16537
16538 Field Format Extract from the example above
16539 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16540 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16541 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16542 4 'to' to
16543 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16544 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16545
16546Detailed fields description :
16547 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16548 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16549 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16550 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16551 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16552 and processed the connection.
16553 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16554
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016555In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16556"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16557connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16558
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016559It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16560will eventually disappear.
16561
16562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165638.2.2. TCP log format
16564---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016565
16566The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16567is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16568information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16569counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16570emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16571environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16572the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16573sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016574specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16575not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16576fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16577marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016578
16579 Example :
16580 frontend fnt
16581 mode tcp
16582 option tcplog
16583 log global
16584 default_backend bck
16585
16586 backend bck
16587 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16588
16589 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16590 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16591 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16592
16593 Field Format Extract from the example above
16594 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16595 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16596 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16597 4 frontend_name fnt
16598 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16599 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16600 7 bytes_read* 212
16601 8 termination_state --
16602 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16603 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16604
16605Detailed fields description :
16606 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016607 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16608 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16609 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016610 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016611 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016612 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016613
16614 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016615 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16616 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16617 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016618
16619 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16620 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16621 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016622 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16623 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16624 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16625 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016626
16627 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16628 and processed the connection.
16629
16630 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16631 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16632 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16633 applications.
16634
16635 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16636 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16637 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16638 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16639 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16640
16641 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16642 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16643 See "Timers" below for more details.
16644
16645 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16646 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16647 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16648 "Timers" below for more details.
16649
16650 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016651 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016652 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16653 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16654 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16655 details.
16656
16657 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16658 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16659 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16660 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16661 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16662
16663 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16664 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16665 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16666 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16667 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16668 for more details.
16669
16670 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016671 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016672 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16673 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16674 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016675 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016676
16677 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16678 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16679 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16680 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16681 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16682 caused by a denial of service attack.
16683
16684 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16685 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16686 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16687 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16688 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16689 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16690 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16691 denial of service attack.
16692
16693 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16694 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16695 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16696 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16697 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16698 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16699 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16700 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16701 be processed than on other servers.
16702
16703 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16704 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16705 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16706 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16707 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16708 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16709 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16710 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16711 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16712 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16713 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16714 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16715 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16716
16717 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16718 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16719 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16720 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16721 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16722 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016723 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016724 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16725
16726 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16727 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16728 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16729 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16730 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16731 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016732 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016733 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16734 occurs.
16735
16736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167378.2.3. HTTP log format
16738----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016739
16740The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16741is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16742the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16743are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16744emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16745generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16746"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16747which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016748frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16749is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016750
16751Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16752slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16753with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16754
16755 Example :
16756 frontend http-in
16757 mode http
16758 option httplog
16759 log global
16760 default_backend bck
16761
16762 backend static
16763 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16764
16765 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16766 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16767 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016768 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016769
16770 Field Format Extract from the example above
16771 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16772 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016773 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016774 4 frontend_name http-in
16775 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016776 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016777 7 status_code 200
16778 8 bytes_read* 2750
16779 9 captured_request_cookie -
16780 10 captured_response_cookie -
16781 11 termination_state ----
16782 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16783 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16784 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16785 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16786 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016787
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016788Detailed fields description :
16789 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016790 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16791 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16792 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016793 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016794 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016795 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016796
16797 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016798 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16799 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16800 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016801
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016802 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16803 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016804
16805 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16806 and processed the connection.
16807
16808 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16809 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16810 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16811
16812 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16813 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16814 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16815 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16816 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16817 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16818
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016819 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16820 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16821 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16822 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16823 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16824 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016825 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16826 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016827
16828 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16829 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016830 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016831
16832 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16833 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016834 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16835 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016836
16837 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16838 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16839 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16840 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16841 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016842 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16843 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016844
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016845 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16846 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16847 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16848 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16849 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16850 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16851 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016852 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016853
16854 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16855 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16856 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16857
16858 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16859 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16860 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16861 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16862 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16863 overflowing.
16864
16865 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16866 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16867 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16868 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16869 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16870 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16871 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16872 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16873
16874 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16875 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16876 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16877 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16878 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16879 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16880 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16881 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16882
16883 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16884 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16885 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16886 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16887 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16888 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16889 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16890
16891 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016892 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016893 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16894 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16895 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016896 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016897 system.
16898
16899 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16900 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16901 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16902 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16903 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16904 caused by a denial of service attack.
16905
16906 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16907 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16908 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16909 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16910 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16911 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16912 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16913 denial of service attack.
16914
16915 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16916 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16917 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16918 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16919 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16920 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16921 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16922 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16923 processed than on other servers.
16924
16925 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16926 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16927 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16928 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16929 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16930 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16931 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16932 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16933 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16934 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16935 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16936 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16937 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16938
16939 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16940 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16941 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16942 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16943 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16944 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016945 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016946 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16947
16948 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16949 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16950 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16951 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16952 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16953 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016954 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016955 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16956 occurs.
16957
16958 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16959 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16960 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16961 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16962 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16963 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16964 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16965 cookies" below for more details.
16966
16967 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16968 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16969 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16970 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16971 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16972 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16973 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16974 and cookies" below for more details.
16975
16976 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16977 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16978 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16979 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16980 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16981 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16982 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16983 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16984
16985
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200169868.2.4. Custom log format
16987------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016988
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016989The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016990mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016991
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016992HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016993Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16994separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16995prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16996
16997Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16998variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016999("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017000
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017001If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017002as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017003less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17004the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17005
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017006Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017007In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017008in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017009
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017010Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17011'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17012https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17013such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17014
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017015Flags are :
17016 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017017 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017018 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17019 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017020
17021 Example:
17022
17023 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17024 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17025
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017026 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17027
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017028At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17029
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017030 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17031 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017032
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017033the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017034
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017035 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17036 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17037 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017038
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017039and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17040
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017041 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17042 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017043
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017044Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17045
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017046 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017047 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017048 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17049 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17050 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017051 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17052 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17053 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017054 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017055 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17056 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017057 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017058 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17059 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017060 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017061 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017062 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017063 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017064 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017065 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017066 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017067 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17068 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17069 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17070 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17071 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017072 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017073 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17074 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017075 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017076 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17077 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017078 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17079 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17080 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017081 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017082 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17083 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017084 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017085 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17086 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17087 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017088 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017089 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017090 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17091 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17092 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17093 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017094 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017095 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017096 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017097 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017098 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017099 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017100 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17101 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17102 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017103 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017104 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17105 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017106 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017107 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17108 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017109 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017110 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017111 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017112 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017113
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017114 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017115
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017116
171178.2.5. Error log format
17118-----------------------
17119
17120When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17121protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17122By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17123"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017124will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017125logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17126
17127The format looks like this :
17128
17129 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17130 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17131 Connection error during SSL handshake
17132
17133 Field Format Extract from the example above
17134 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17135 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17136 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17137 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17138 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17139
17140These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17141failures.
17142
17143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171448.3. Advanced logging options
17145-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017146
17147Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17148just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17149options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17150for more information about their usage.
17151
17152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171538.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17154------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017155
17156It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17157haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17158commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17159monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17160ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17161
17162 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17163 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17164 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17165 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17166
17167 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17168 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17169 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017170 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017171 such as other load-balancers.
17172
17173 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17174 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17175 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17176
17177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171788.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17179----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017180
17181The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17182what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17183or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017184"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017185just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17186log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17187after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17188is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17189with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17190with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17191
17192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17194------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017195
17196Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17197for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17198"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17199retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17200raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17201a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17202file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17203you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17204"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17205
17206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17208--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017209
17210Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17211multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17212them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17213"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17214logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17215error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17216and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17217too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17218useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17219alternative.
17220
17221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172228.4. Timing events
17223------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017224
17225Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17226reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17227the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17228frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017229mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17230addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17231
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017232Timings events in HTTP mode:
17233
17234 first request 2nd request
17235 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17236 t tr t tr ...
17237 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17238 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17239 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17240 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17241 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17242
17243Timings events in TCP mode:
17244
17245 TCP session
17246 |<----------------->|
17247 t t
17248 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17249 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17250 |<------ Tt ------->|
17251
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017252 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017253 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017254 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17255 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17256 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017257 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017258 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17259 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17260 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17261 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017262
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017263 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17264 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17265 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017266 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17267 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17268 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17269 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17270 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17271 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017272
17273 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17274 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17275 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17276 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17277 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17278 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17279 request typed by hand during a test.
17280
17281 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17282 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017283 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017284 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17285 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17286 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17287 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017288
17289 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17290 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17291 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17292 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17293 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17294
17295 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17296 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17297 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17298 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17299 connection never established.
17300
17301 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17302 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17303 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17304 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17305 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17306 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17307 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17308 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17309 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17310 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17311 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17312
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017313 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17314 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17315 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17316 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17317 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17318 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17319
17320 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17321
17322 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17323 "Ta" can never be negative.
17324
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017325 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17326 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017327 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17328 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017329 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017330
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017331 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017332
17333 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017334 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17335 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017336
17337These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17338protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17339that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017340due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17341"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17342that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017343
17344Most common cases :
17345
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017346 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17347 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17348 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17349 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17350 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17351 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17352 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17353 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17354 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17355 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17356 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017357 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017358
17359 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17360 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17361 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17362 of ms on remote networks.
17363
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017364 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17365 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17366 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017367
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017368 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17369 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17370 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17371 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17372 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17373 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17374 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17375 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17376 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017377
17378Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17379
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017380 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017381 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017382 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017383
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017384 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017385 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17386 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17387
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017388 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017389 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17390 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17391 flags.
17392
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017393 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17394 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017395 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17396 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17397 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17398 the client connection was maintained open.
17399
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017400 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017401 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017402 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017403 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17404
17405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174068.5. Session state at disconnection
17407-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017408
17409TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17410"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
174112-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17412each of which has a special meaning :
17413
17414 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17415 session to terminate :
17416
17417 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17418
17419 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17420 server explicitly refused it.
17421
17422 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17423 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17424 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17425 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017426 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017427
17428 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17429 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017430
17431 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17432 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17433 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17434 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17435 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17436
17437 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17438 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17439 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17440 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17441 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17442
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017443 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17444 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17445
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017446 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17447 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17448 backup connections when going up.
17449
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017450 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17451
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017452 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17453 send or receive data.
17454
17455 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17456 send or receive data.
17457
17458 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17459 with nothing left in the buffers.
17460
17461 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17462
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017463 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017464 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17465
17466 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17467 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17468 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17469 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17470 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17471
17472 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17473 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17474
17475 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17476 server (HTTP only).
17477
17478 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17479
17480 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17481 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17482 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17483
17484 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17485 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17486 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17487
17488 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17489
17490 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17491 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17492
17493 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17494 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17495 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17496
17497 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17498 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017499 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17500 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017501
17502 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17503 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17504 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17505 another server.
17506
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017507 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017508 server.
17509
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017510 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17511 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17512 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17513 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17514
17515 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17516 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17517 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17518 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17519
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017520 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17521 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17522 "use-server" rule).
17523
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017524 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17525
17526 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17527 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17528
17529 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17530
17531 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17532 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17533 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17534
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017535 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17536 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017537 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017538 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17539 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17540
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017541 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17542
17543 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17544 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17545
17546 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17547
17548 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17549
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017550The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17551was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017552helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17553starvation, attacks, etc...
17554
17555The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17556alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17557easier finding and understanding.
17558
17559 Flags Reason
17560
17561 -- Normal termination.
17562
17563 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17564 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17565 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17566 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17567
17568 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17569 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17570 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17571 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17572 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17573 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017574
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017575 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17576 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017577 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017578
17579 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17580 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17581 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17582
17583 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17584 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17585 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17586 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17587 the server takes too long to respond.
17588
17589 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17590 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17591 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17592 long a time to respond.
17593
17594 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17595 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17596 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17597 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017598 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17599 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017600
17601 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17602 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17603 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17604 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17605 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017606 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017607 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17608 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17609 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17610 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17611 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17612 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17613 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17614 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017615 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017616 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17617 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17618 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017619
17620 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17621 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017622 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17623 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17624 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17625 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017626
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017627 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17628 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017630 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017631 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17632 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017633 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017634 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17635 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17636
17637 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17638 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17639 503 or 504 here.
17640
17641 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17642 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17643 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17644 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17645 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17646
17647 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17648 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017649 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017650 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17651 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17652
17653 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17654 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17655 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17656 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17657 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17658 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17659 between haproxy and the server.
17660
17661 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17662 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17663 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17664 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17665 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17666 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17667 solution is to fix the application.
17668
17669 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17670 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17671 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17672 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17673 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17674 external attacks.
17675
17676 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17677 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017678 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017679 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17680 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17681
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017682 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17683 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17684 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017685 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017686 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017688 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17689 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17690 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17691 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017692 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17693 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17694 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17695 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17696 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017697
17698 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17699 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17700 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17701 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17702
17703 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17704 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17705 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17706 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17707
17708 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17709 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17710 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17711 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17712
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017713The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17714persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17715important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17716re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17717
17718 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17719
17720 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17721 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17722 set on a GET request.
17723
17724 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17725 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017726 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017727 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17728
17729 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17730 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17731 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17732
17733 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17734 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17735 already got a cookie.
17736
17737 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17738 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17739 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17740 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17741 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17742
17743 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17744 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17745 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17746
17747 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17748 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17749 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17750
17751 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17752 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17753
17754 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17755 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17756 then advertised in the response.
17757
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177598.6. Non-printable characters
17760-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017761
17762In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17763consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17764converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17765prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17766being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17767escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17768is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17769'}' when logging headers.
17770
17771Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17772issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17773containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17774
17775Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17776the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17777performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17778
17779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177808.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17781---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017782
17783Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17784achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017785section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017786cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17787the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17788the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017789locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017790not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17791user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17792a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17793wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17794
17795 Examples :
17796 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17797 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17798
17799 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17800 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17801
17802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17804---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017805
17806Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17807proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17808the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17809server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17810
17811Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17812response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017813section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017814
17815It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017816time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17817appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017818are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17819and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17820follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17821request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17822in the logs.
17823
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017824As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17825frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17826an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17827
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017828 Example :
17829 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17830 listen proxy-out
17831 mode http
17832 option httplog
17833 option logasap
17834 log global
17835 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17836
17837 # log the name of the virtual server
17838 capture request header Host len 20
17839
17840 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17841 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17842
17843 # log the beginning of the referrer
17844 capture request header Referer len 20
17845
17846 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17847 capture response header Server len 20
17848
17849 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17850 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017852 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017853 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17854
17855 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17856 capture response header Via len 20
17857
17858 # log the URL location during a redirection
17859 capture response header Location len 20
17860
17861 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17862 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17863 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17864 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17865 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17866
17867 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17868 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17869 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17870 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017871 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017872
17873 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17874 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17875 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17876 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17877 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017878 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017879
17880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178818.9. Examples of logs
17882---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017883
17884These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17885them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17886reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17887
17888 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17889 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17890 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17891
17892 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17893 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17894
17895 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17896 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17897 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17898
17899 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17900 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17901
17902 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17903 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17904 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17905
17906 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017907 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017908 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17909 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17910
17911 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17912 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17913 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17914
17915 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17916 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017917 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017918 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17919 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17920 to return the 502 and not the server.
17921
17922 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017923 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017924
17925 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17926 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17927 Nothing was sent to any server.
17928
17929 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17930 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17931
17932 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17933 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017934 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017935 send a 408 return code to the client.
17936
17937 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17938 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17939
17940 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17941 5 seconds ("c----").
17942
17943 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17944 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017945 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017946
17947 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017948 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17950 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17951 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17952 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17953 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017954
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017955
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200179569. Supported filters
17957--------------------
17958
17959Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17960accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17961unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17962
17963See also : "filter"
17964
179659.1. Trace
17966----------
17967
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017968filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017969
17970 Arguments:
17971 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17972 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17973
17974 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17975 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17976 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17977 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17978
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017979 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017980 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17981 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17982 amount of the parsed data.
17983
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017984 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017985
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017986This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17987callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17988information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17989filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17990
17991Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17992tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17993a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17994
17995
179969.2. HTTP compression
17997---------------------
17998
17999filter compression
18000
18001The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18002keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018003when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18004it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18005response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18006line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18007cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18008the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018009
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018010See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018011
18012
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200180139.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18014--------------------------------------------
18015
18016filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18017
18018 Arguments :
18019
18020 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18021 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18022 parsed.
18023
18024 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18025 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18026 part must be placed in its own scope.
18027
18028The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18029external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018030streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018031exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18032also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18033
18034SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18035the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18036
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018037For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018038"doc/SPOE.txt".
18039
18040Important note:
18041 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18042 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18043
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100180449.4. Cache
18045----------
18046
18047filter cache <name>
18048
18049 Arguments :
18050
18051 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18052
18053The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18054"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18055cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018056other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18057the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18058mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18059filter other than the compression is used for the same
18060listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18061order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018062
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018063See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018064
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001806510. Cache
18066---------
18067
18068HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18069(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18070RAM.
18071
18072The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018073this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018074
18075If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18076independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18077when we try to allocate a new one.
18078
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018079The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018080
18081It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18082"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18083for more details.
18084
18085When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18086replaced by "<CACHE>".
18087
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001808810.1. Limitation
18089----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018090
18091The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18092
18093- If the response is not a 200
18094- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018095- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018096- If the response is not cacheable
18097
18098- If the request is not a GET
18099- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018100- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018101
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018102Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18103filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18104can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18105example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18106"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018107
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001810810.2. Setup
18109-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018110
18111To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18112the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18113
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001811410.2.1. Cache section
18115---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018116
18117cache <name>
18118 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18119 size of cache is mandatory.
18120
18121total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018122 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018123 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018124
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018125max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018126 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18127 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18128 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018129
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018130max-age <seconds>
18131 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18132 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18133 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18134 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18135 default.
18136
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001813710.2.2. Proxy section
18138---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018139
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018140http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018141 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18142 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18143 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18144 after this one.
18145
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018146http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018147 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18148 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18149 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18150 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18151
18152
18153Example:
18154
18155 backend bck1
18156 mode http
18157
18158 http-request cache-use foobar
18159 http-response cache-store foobar
18160 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18161
18162 cache foobar
18163 total-max-size 4
18164 max-age 240
18165
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018166/*
18167 * Local variables:
18168 * fill-column: 79
18169 * End:
18170 */